7
|
1 /* vi:set ts=8 sts=4 sw=4:
|
|
2 *
|
|
3 * VIM - Vi IMproved by Bram Moolenaar
|
|
4 * GUI/Motif support by Robert Webb
|
|
5 * Macintosh port by Dany St-Amant
|
|
6 * and Axel Kielhorn
|
1106
|
7 * Port to MPW by Bernhard Pruemmer
|
7
|
8 * Initial Carbon port by Ammon Skidmore
|
|
9 *
|
|
10 * Do ":help uganda" in Vim to read copying and usage conditions.
|
|
11 * Do ":help credits" in Vim to see a list of people who contributed.
|
|
12 * See README.txt for an overview of the Vim source code.
|
|
13 */
|
|
14
|
|
15 /*
|
593
|
16 * NOTES: - Vim 7+ does not support classic MacOS. Please use Vim 6.x
|
856
|
17 * - Comments mentioning FAQ refer to the book:
|
|
18 * "Macworld Mac Programming FAQs" from "IDG Books"
|
7
|
19 */
|
|
20
|
|
21 /*
|
|
22 * TODO: Change still to merge from the macvim's iDisk
|
|
23 *
|
|
24 * error_ga, mch_errmsg, Navigation's changes in gui_mch_browse
|
|
25 * uses of MenuItemIndex, changes in gui_mch_set_shellsize,
|
|
26 * ScrapManager error handling.
|
|
27 * Comments about function remaining to Carbonize.
|
|
28 *
|
|
29 */
|
|
30
|
1107
|
31 /* TODO (Jussi)
|
|
32 * * Clipboard does not work (at least some cases)
|
|
33 * * ATSU font rendering has some problems
|
|
34 * * Investigate and remove dead code (there is still lots of that)
|
|
35 */
|
7
|
36
|
|
37 #include <Devices.h> /* included first to avoid CR problems */
|
|
38 #include "vim.h"
|
|
39
|
593
|
40 #define USE_CARBONIZED
|
|
41 #define USE_AEVENT /* Enable AEVENT */
|
|
42 #undef USE_OFFSETED_WINDOW /* Debugging feature: start Vim window OFFSETed */
|
7
|
43
|
|
44 /* Compile as CodeWarior External Editor */
|
|
45 #if defined(FEAT_CW_EDITOR) && !defined(USE_AEVENT)
|
|
46 # define USE_AEVENT /* Need Apple Event Support */
|
|
47 #endif
|
|
48
|
9
|
49 /* Vim's Scrap flavor. */
|
|
50 #define VIMSCRAPFLAVOR 'VIM!'
|
838
|
51 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
|
|
52 # define SCRAPTEXTFLAVOR kScrapFlavorTypeUnicode
|
|
53 #else
|
|
54 # define SCRAPTEXTFLAVOR kScrapFlavorTypeText
|
|
55 #endif
|
9
|
56
|
7
|
57 static EventHandlerUPP mouseWheelHandlerUPP = NULL;
|
593
|
58 SInt32 gMacSystemVersion;
|
|
59
|
766
|
60 #ifdef MACOS_CONVERT
|
|
61 # define USE_CARBONKEYHANDLER
|
168
|
62 static EventHandlerUPP keyEventHandlerUPP = NULL;
|
|
63 #endif
|
|
64
|
7
|
65
|
|
66 /* Include some file. TODO: move into os_mac.h */
|
|
67 #include <Menus.h>
|
|
68 #include <Resources.h>
|
|
69 #include <Processes.h>
|
|
70 #ifdef USE_AEVENT
|
|
71 # include <AppleEvents.h>
|
|
72 # include <AERegistry.h>
|
|
73 #endif
|
|
74 # include <Gestalt.h>
|
|
75 #if UNIVERSAL_INTERFACES_VERSION >= 0x0330
|
|
76 # include <ControlDefinitions.h>
|
|
77 # include <Navigation.h> /* Navigation only part of ?? */
|
|
78 #endif
|
|
79
|
593
|
80 /* Help Manager (balloon.h, HM prefixed functions) are not supported
|
|
81 * under Carbon (Jussi) */
|
|
82 # if 0
|
7
|
83 /* New Help Interface for Mac, not implemented yet.*/
|
593
|
84 # include <MacHelp.h>
|
|
85 # endif
|
7
|
86
|
|
87 /*
|
593
|
88 * These seem to be rectangle options. Why are they not found in
|
|
89 * headers? (Jussi)
|
7
|
90 */
|
|
91 #define kNothing 0
|
|
92 #define kCreateEmpty 2 /*1*/
|
|
93 #define kCreateRect 2
|
|
94 #define kDestroy 3
|
|
95
|
|
96 /*
|
|
97 * Dany: Don't like those...
|
|
98 */
|
|
99 #define topLeft(r) (((Point*)&(r))[0])
|
|
100 #define botRight(r) (((Point*)&(r))[1])
|
|
101
|
|
102
|
|
103 /* Time of last mouse click, to detect double-click */
|
|
104 static long lastMouseTick = 0;
|
|
105
|
|
106 /* ??? */
|
|
107 static RgnHandle cursorRgn;
|
|
108 static RgnHandle dragRgn;
|
|
109 static Rect dragRect;
|
|
110 static short dragRectEnbl;
|
|
111 static short dragRectControl;
|
|
112
|
|
113 /* This variable is set when waiting for an event, which is the only moment
|
|
114 * scrollbar dragging can be done directly. It's not allowed while commands
|
|
115 * are executed, because it may move the cursor and that may cause unexpected
|
|
116 * problems (e.g., while ":s" is working).
|
|
117 */
|
|
118 static int allow_scrollbar = FALSE;
|
|
119
|
|
120 /* Last mouse click caused contextual menu, (to provide proper release) */
|
|
121 static short clickIsPopup;
|
|
122
|
|
123 /* Feedback Action for Scrollbar */
|
|
124 ControlActionUPP gScrollAction;
|
|
125 ControlActionUPP gScrollDrag;
|
|
126
|
|
127 /* Keeping track of which scrollbar is being dragged */
|
|
128 static ControlHandle dragged_sb = NULL;
|
|
129
|
13
|
130 static struct
|
|
131 {
|
|
132 FMFontFamily family;
|
|
133 FMFontSize size;
|
|
134 FMFontStyle style;
|
|
135 Boolean isPanelVisible;
|
|
136 } gFontPanelInfo = { 0, 0, 0, false };
|
593
|
137
|
766
|
138 #ifdef MACOS_CONVERT
|
168
|
139 # define USE_ATSUI_DRAWING
|
|
140 ATSUStyle gFontStyle;
|
|
141 Boolean gIsFontFallbackSet;
|
|
142 #endif
|
|
143
|
7
|
144 /* Colors Macros */
|
|
145 #define RGB(r,g,b) ((r) << 16) + ((g) << 8) + (b)
|
|
146 #define Red(c) ((c & 0x00FF0000) >> 16)
|
|
147 #define Green(c) ((c & 0x0000FF00) >> 8)
|
|
148 #define Blue(c) ((c & 0x000000FF) >> 0)
|
|
149
|
|
150 /* Key mapping */
|
|
151
|
|
152 #define vk_Esc 0x35 /* -> 1B */
|
|
153
|
|
154 #define vk_F1 0x7A /* -> 10 */
|
|
155 #define vk_F2 0x78 /*0x63*/
|
|
156 #define vk_F3 0x63 /*0x76*/
|
|
157 #define vk_F4 0x76 /*0x60*/
|
|
158 #define vk_F5 0x60 /*0x61*/
|
|
159 #define vk_F6 0x61 /*0x62*/
|
|
160 #define vk_F7 0x62 /*0x63*/ /*?*/
|
|
161 #define vk_F8 0x64
|
|
162 #define vk_F9 0x65
|
|
163 #define vk_F10 0x6D
|
|
164 #define vk_F11 0x67
|
|
165 #define vk_F12 0x6F
|
|
166 #define vk_F13 0x69
|
|
167 #define vk_F14 0x6B
|
|
168 #define vk_F15 0x71
|
|
169
|
|
170 #define vk_Clr 0x47 /* -> 1B (ESC) */
|
|
171 #define vk_Enter 0x4C /* -> 03 */
|
|
172
|
|
173 #define vk_Space 0x31 /* -> 20 */
|
|
174 #define vk_Tab 0x30 /* -> 09 */
|
|
175 #define vk_Return 0x24 /* -> 0D */
|
|
176 /* This is wrong for OSX, what is it for? */
|
|
177 #define vk_Delete 0X08 /* -> 08 BackSpace */
|
|
178
|
|
179 #define vk_Help 0x72 /* -> 05 */
|
|
180 #define vk_Home 0x73 /* -> 01 */
|
|
181 #define vk_PageUp 0x74 /* -> 0D */
|
|
182 #define vk_FwdDelete 0x75 /* -> 7F */
|
|
183 #define vk_End 0x77 /* -> 04 */
|
|
184 #define vk_PageDown 0x79 /* -> 0C */
|
|
185
|
|
186 #define vk_Up 0x7E /* -> 1E */
|
|
187 #define vk_Down 0x7D /* -> 1F */
|
|
188 #define vk_Left 0x7B /* -> 1C */
|
|
189 #define vk_Right 0x7C /* -> 1D */
|
|
190
|
|
191 #define vk_Undo vk_F1
|
|
192 #define vk_Cut vk_F2
|
|
193 #define vk_Copy vk_F3
|
|
194 #define vk_Paste vk_F4
|
|
195 #define vk_PrintScreen vk_F13
|
|
196 #define vk_SCrollLock vk_F14
|
|
197 #define vk_Pause vk_F15
|
|
198 #define vk_NumLock vk_Clr
|
|
199 #define vk_Insert vk_Help
|
|
200
|
|
201 #define KeySym char
|
|
202
|
|
203 static struct
|
|
204 {
|
|
205 KeySym key_sym;
|
|
206 char_u vim_code0;
|
|
207 char_u vim_code1;
|
|
208 } special_keys[] =
|
|
209 {
|
|
210 {vk_Up, 'k', 'u'},
|
|
211 {vk_Down, 'k', 'd'},
|
|
212 {vk_Left, 'k', 'l'},
|
|
213 {vk_Right, 'k', 'r'},
|
|
214
|
|
215 {vk_F1, 'k', '1'},
|
|
216 {vk_F2, 'k', '2'},
|
|
217 {vk_F3, 'k', '3'},
|
|
218 {vk_F4, 'k', '4'},
|
|
219 {vk_F5, 'k', '5'},
|
|
220 {vk_F6, 'k', '6'},
|
|
221 {vk_F7, 'k', '7'},
|
|
222 {vk_F8, 'k', '8'},
|
|
223 {vk_F9, 'k', '9'},
|
|
224 {vk_F10, 'k', ';'},
|
|
225
|
|
226 {vk_F11, 'F', '1'},
|
|
227 {vk_F12, 'F', '2'},
|
|
228 {vk_F13, 'F', '3'},
|
|
229 {vk_F14, 'F', '4'},
|
|
230 {vk_F15, 'F', '5'},
|
|
231
|
|
232 /* {XK_Help, '%', '1'}, */
|
|
233 /* {XK_Undo, '&', '8'}, */
|
|
234 /* {XK_BackSpace, 'k', 'b'}, */
|
|
235 #ifndef MACOS_X
|
|
236 {vk_Delete, 'k', 'b'},
|
|
237 #endif
|
|
238 {vk_Insert, 'k', 'I'},
|
|
239 {vk_FwdDelete, 'k', 'D'},
|
|
240 {vk_Home, 'k', 'h'},
|
|
241 {vk_End, '@', '7'},
|
|
242 /* {XK_Prior, 'k', 'P'}, */
|
|
243 /* {XK_Next, 'k', 'N'}, */
|
|
244 /* {XK_Print, '%', '9'}, */
|
|
245
|
|
246 {vk_PageUp, 'k', 'P'},
|
|
247 {vk_PageDown, 'k', 'N'},
|
|
248
|
|
249 /* End of list marker: */
|
|
250 {(KeySym)0, 0, 0}
|
|
251 };
|
|
252
|
|
253 /*
|
|
254 * ------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
255 * Forward declaration (for those needed)
|
|
256 * ------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
257 */
|
|
258
|
|
259 #ifdef USE_AEVENT
|
9
|
260 OSErr HandleUnusedParms(const AppleEvent *theAEvent);
|
7
|
261 #endif
|
|
262
|
1106
|
263 #ifdef FEAT_GUI_TABLINE
|
|
264 static void initialise_tabline(void);
|
|
265 static WindowRef drawer = NULL; // TODO: put into gui.h
|
|
266 #endif
|
|
267
|
7
|
268 /*
|
|
269 * ------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
270 * Conversion Utility
|
|
271 * ------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
272 */
|
|
273
|
|
274 /*
|
|
275 * C2Pascal_save
|
|
276 *
|
|
277 * Allocate memory and convert the C-String passed in
|
|
278 * into a pascal string
|
|
279 *
|
|
280 */
|
|
281
|
593
|
282 char_u *
|
|
283 C2Pascal_save(char_u *Cstring)
|
7
|
284 {
|
|
285 char_u *PascalString;
|
|
286 int len;
|
|
287
|
|
288 if (Cstring == NULL)
|
|
289 return NULL;
|
|
290
|
|
291 len = STRLEN(Cstring);
|
|
292
|
|
293 if (len > 255) /* Truncate if necessary */
|
|
294 len = 255;
|
|
295
|
|
296 PascalString = alloc(len + 1);
|
|
297 if (PascalString != NULL)
|
|
298 {
|
|
299 mch_memmove(PascalString + 1, Cstring, len);
|
|
300 PascalString[0] = len;
|
|
301 }
|
|
302
|
|
303 return PascalString;
|
|
304 }
|
|
305
|
|
306 /*
|
|
307 * C2Pascal_save_and_remove_backslash
|
|
308 *
|
|
309 * Allocate memory and convert the C-String passed in
|
|
310 * into a pascal string. Also remove the backslash at the same time
|
|
311 *
|
|
312 */
|
|
313
|
593
|
314 char_u *
|
|
315 C2Pascal_save_and_remove_backslash(char_u *Cstring)
|
7
|
316 {
|
|
317 char_u *PascalString;
|
|
318 int len;
|
|
319 char_u *p, *c;
|
|
320
|
|
321 len = STRLEN(Cstring);
|
|
322
|
|
323 if (len > 255) /* Truncate if necessary */
|
|
324 len = 255;
|
|
325
|
|
326 PascalString = alloc(len + 1);
|
|
327 if (PascalString != NULL)
|
|
328 {
|
|
329 for (c = Cstring, p = PascalString+1, len = 0; (*c != 0) && (len < 255); c++)
|
|
330 {
|
|
331 if ((*c == '\\') && (c[1] != 0))
|
|
332 {
|
|
333 c++;
|
|
334 }
|
|
335 *p = *c;
|
|
336 p++;
|
|
337 len++;
|
|
338 }
|
|
339 PascalString[0] = len;
|
|
340 }
|
|
341
|
|
342 return PascalString;
|
|
343 }
|
|
344
|
|
345 /*
|
|
346 * Convert the modifiers of an Event into vim's modifiers (mouse)
|
|
347 */
|
|
348
|
|
349 int_u
|
|
350 EventModifiers2VimMouseModifiers(EventModifiers macModifiers)
|
|
351 {
|
|
352 int_u vimModifiers = 0x00;
|
|
353
|
|
354 if (macModifiers & (shiftKey | rightShiftKey))
|
|
355 vimModifiers |= MOUSE_SHIFT;
|
|
356 if (macModifiers & (controlKey | rightControlKey))
|
|
357 vimModifiers |= MOUSE_CTRL;
|
|
358 if (macModifiers & (optionKey | rightOptionKey))
|
|
359 vimModifiers |= MOUSE_ALT;
|
|
360 #if 0
|
|
361 /* Not yet supported */
|
|
362 if (macModifiers & (cmdKey)) /* There's no rightCmdKey */
|
|
363 vimModifiers |= MOUSE_CMD;
|
|
364 #endif
|
|
365 return (vimModifiers);
|
|
366 }
|
|
367
|
|
368 /*
|
|
369 * Convert the modifiers of an Event into vim's modifiers (keys)
|
|
370 */
|
|
371
|
|
372 static int_u
|
|
373 EventModifiers2VimModifiers(EventModifiers macModifiers)
|
|
374 {
|
|
375 int_u vimModifiers = 0x00;
|
|
376
|
|
377 if (macModifiers & (shiftKey | rightShiftKey))
|
|
378 vimModifiers |= MOD_MASK_SHIFT;
|
|
379 if (macModifiers & (controlKey | rightControlKey))
|
|
380 vimModifiers |= MOD_MASK_CTRL;
|
|
381 if (macModifiers & (optionKey | rightOptionKey))
|
|
382 vimModifiers |= MOD_MASK_ALT;
|
|
383 #ifdef USE_CMD_KEY
|
|
384 if (macModifiers & (cmdKey)) /* There's no rightCmdKey */
|
|
385 vimModifiers |= MOD_MASK_CMD;
|
|
386 #endif
|
|
387 return (vimModifiers);
|
|
388 }
|
|
389
|
|
390 /* Convert a string representing a point size into pixels. The string should
|
|
391 * be a positive decimal number, with an optional decimal point (eg, "12", or
|
|
392 * "10.5"). The pixel value is returned, and a pointer to the next unconverted
|
|
393 * character is stored in *end. The flag "vertical" says whether this
|
|
394 * calculation is for a vertical (height) size or a horizontal (width) one.
|
|
395 *
|
|
396 * From gui_w48.c
|
|
397 */
|
|
398 static int
|
|
399 points_to_pixels(char_u *str, char_u **end, int vertical)
|
|
400 {
|
|
401 int pixels;
|
|
402 int points = 0;
|
|
403 int divisor = 0;
|
|
404
|
|
405 while (*str)
|
|
406 {
|
|
407 if (*str == '.' && divisor == 0)
|
|
408 {
|
|
409 /* Start keeping a divisor, for later */
|
|
410 divisor = 1;
|
|
411 continue;
|
|
412 }
|
|
413
|
|
414 if (!isdigit(*str))
|
|
415 break;
|
|
416
|
|
417 points *= 10;
|
|
418 points += *str - '0';
|
|
419 divisor *= 10;
|
|
420
|
|
421 ++str;
|
|
422 }
|
|
423
|
|
424 if (divisor == 0)
|
|
425 divisor = 1;
|
|
426
|
|
427 pixels = points/divisor;
|
|
428 *end = str;
|
|
429 return pixels;
|
|
430 }
|
|
431
|
766
|
432 #ifdef MACOS_CONVERT
|
168
|
433 /*
|
|
434 * Deletes all traces of any Windows-style mnemonic text (including any
|
|
435 * parentheses) from a menu item and returns the cleaned menu item title.
|
|
436 * The caller is responsible for releasing the returned string.
|
|
437 */
|
|
438 static CFStringRef
|
593
|
439 menu_title_removing_mnemonic(vimmenu_T *menu)
|
168
|
440 {
|
|
441 CFStringRef name;
|
|
442 size_t menuTitleLen;
|
|
443 CFIndex displayLen;
|
|
444 CFRange mnemonicStart;
|
|
445 CFRange mnemonicEnd;
|
|
446 CFMutableStringRef cleanedName;
|
|
447
|
|
448 menuTitleLen = STRLEN(menu->dname);
|
|
449 name = mac_enc_to_cfstring(menu->dname, menuTitleLen);
|
|
450
|
|
451 if (name)
|
|
452 {
|
|
453 /* Simple mnemonic-removal algorithm, assumes single parenthesized
|
|
454 * mnemonic character towards the end of the menu text */
|
|
455 mnemonicStart = CFStringFind(name, CFSTR("("), kCFCompareBackwards);
|
|
456 displayLen = CFStringGetLength(name);
|
|
457
|
|
458 if (mnemonicStart.location != kCFNotFound
|
|
459 && (mnemonicStart.location + 2) < displayLen
|
|
460 && CFStringGetCharacterAtIndex(name,
|
|
461 mnemonicStart.location + 1) == (UniChar)menu->mnemonic)
|
|
462 {
|
|
463 if (CFStringFindWithOptions(name, CFSTR(")"),
|
|
464 CFRangeMake(mnemonicStart.location + 1,
|
|
465 displayLen - mnemonicStart.location - 1),
|
|
466 kCFCompareBackwards, &mnemonicEnd) &&
|
|
467 (mnemonicStart.location + 2) == mnemonicEnd.location)
|
|
468 {
|
|
469 cleanedName = CFStringCreateMutableCopy(NULL, 0, name);
|
|
470 if (cleanedName)
|
|
471 {
|
|
472 CFStringDelete(cleanedName,
|
|
473 CFRangeMake(mnemonicStart.location,
|
|
474 mnemonicEnd.location + 1 -
|
|
475 mnemonicStart.location));
|
|
476
|
|
477 CFRelease(name);
|
|
478 name = cleanedName;
|
|
479 }
|
|
480 }
|
|
481 }
|
|
482 }
|
|
483
|
|
484 return name;
|
|
485 }
|
|
486 #endif
|
|
487
|
7
|
488 /*
|
|
489 * Convert a list of FSSpec aliases into a list of fullpathname
|
|
490 * character strings.
|
|
491 */
|
|
492
|
593
|
493 char_u **
|
|
494 new_fnames_from_AEDesc(AEDesc *theList, long *numFiles, OSErr *error)
|
7
|
495 {
|
|
496 char_u **fnames = NULL;
|
|
497 OSErr newError;
|
|
498 long fileCount;
|
|
499 FSSpec fileToOpen;
|
|
500 long actualSize;
|
|
501 AEKeyword dummyKeyword;
|
|
502 DescType dummyType;
|
|
503
|
|
504 /* Get number of files in list */
|
|
505 *error = AECountItems(theList, numFiles);
|
|
506 if (*error)
|
1107
|
507 return fnames;
|
7
|
508
|
|
509 /* Allocate the pointer list */
|
|
510 fnames = (char_u **) alloc(*numFiles * sizeof(char_u *));
|
|
511
|
|
512 /* Empty out the list */
|
|
513 for (fileCount = 0; fileCount < *numFiles; fileCount++)
|
|
514 fnames[fileCount] = NULL;
|
|
515
|
|
516 /* Scan the list of FSSpec */
|
|
517 for (fileCount = 1; fileCount <= *numFiles; fileCount++)
|
|
518 {
|
|
519 /* Get the alias for the nth file, convert to an FSSpec */
|
|
520 newError = AEGetNthPtr(theList, fileCount, typeFSS,
|
|
521 &dummyKeyword, &dummyType,
|
|
522 (Ptr) &fileToOpen, sizeof(FSSpec), &actualSize);
|
|
523 if (newError)
|
|
524 {
|
|
525 /* Caller is able to clean up */
|
|
526 /* TODO: Should be clean up or not? For safety. */
|
1107
|
527 return fnames;
|
7
|
528 }
|
|
529
|
|
530 /* Convert the FSSpec to a pathname */
|
9
|
531 fnames[fileCount - 1] = FullPathFromFSSpec_save(fileToOpen);
|
7
|
532 }
|
|
533
|
|
534 return (fnames);
|
|
535 }
|
|
536
|
|
537 /*
|
|
538 * ------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
539 * CodeWarrior External Editor Support
|
|
540 * ------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
541 */
|
|
542 #ifdef FEAT_CW_EDITOR
|
|
543
|
|
544 /*
|
|
545 * Handle the Window Search event from CodeWarrior
|
|
546 *
|
|
547 * Description
|
|
548 * -----------
|
|
549 *
|
|
550 * The IDE sends the Window Search AppleEvent to the editor when it
|
|
551 * needs to know whether a particular file is open in the editor.
|
|
552 *
|
|
553 * Event Reply
|
|
554 * -----------
|
|
555 *
|
|
556 * None. Put data in the location specified in the structure received.
|
|
557 *
|
|
558 * Remarks
|
|
559 * -------
|
|
560 *
|
|
561 * When the editor receives this event, determine whether the specified
|
|
562 * file is open. If it is, return the modification date/time for that file
|
|
563 * in the appropriate location specified in the structure. If the file is
|
9
|
564 * not opened, put the value fnfErr(file not found) in that location.
|
7
|
565 *
|
|
566 */
|
|
567
|
|
568 typedef struct WindowSearch WindowSearch;
|
|
569 struct WindowSearch /* for handling class 'KAHL', event 'SRCH', keyDirectObject typeChar*/
|
|
570 {
|
|
571 FSSpec theFile; // identifies the file
|
|
572 long *theDate; // where to put the modification date/time
|
|
573 };
|
|
574
|
9
|
575 pascal OSErr
|
593
|
576 Handle_KAHL_SRCH_AE(
|
|
577 const AppleEvent *theAEvent,
|
|
578 AppleEvent *theReply,
|
|
579 long refCon)
|
7
|
580 {
|
|
581 OSErr error = noErr;
|
|
582 buf_T *buf;
|
|
583 int foundFile = false;
|
|
584 DescType typeCode;
|
|
585 WindowSearch SearchData;
|
|
586 Size actualSize;
|
|
587
|
|
588 error = AEGetParamPtr(theAEvent, keyDirectObject, typeChar, &typeCode, (Ptr) &SearchData, sizeof(WindowSearch), &actualSize);
|
|
589 if (error)
|
1107
|
590 return error;
|
7
|
591
|
9
|
592 error = HandleUnusedParms(theAEvent);
|
7
|
593 if (error)
|
1107
|
594 return error;
|
7
|
595
|
|
596 for (buf = firstbuf; buf != NULL; buf = buf->b_next)
|
|
597 if (buf->b_ml.ml_mfp != NULL
|
|
598 && SearchData.theFile.parID == buf->b_FSSpec.parID
|
|
599 && SearchData.theFile.name[0] == buf->b_FSSpec.name[0]
|
|
600 && STRNCMP(SearchData.theFile.name, buf->b_FSSpec.name, buf->b_FSSpec.name[0] + 1) == 0)
|
|
601 {
|
|
602 foundFile = true;
|
|
603 break;
|
|
604 }
|
|
605
|
|
606 if (foundFile == false)
|
|
607 *SearchData.theDate = fnfErr;
|
|
608 else
|
|
609 *SearchData.theDate = buf->b_mtime;
|
|
610
|
|
611 return error;
|
|
612 };
|
|
613
|
|
614 /*
|
|
615 * Handle the Modified (from IDE to Editor) event from CodeWarrior
|
|
616 *
|
|
617 * Description
|
|
618 * -----------
|
|
619 *
|
|
620 * The IDE sends this event to the external editor when it wants to
|
|
621 * know which files that are open in the editor have been modified.
|
|
622 *
|
|
623 * Parameters None.
|
|
624 * ----------
|
|
625 *
|
|
626 * Event Reply
|
|
627 * -----------
|
|
628 * The reply for this event is:
|
|
629 *
|
|
630 * keyDirectObject typeAEList required
|
|
631 * each element in the list is a structure of typeChar
|
|
632 *
|
|
633 * Remarks
|
|
634 * -------
|
|
635 *
|
|
636 * When building the reply event, include one element in the list for
|
|
637 * each open file that has been modified.
|
|
638 *
|
|
639 */
|
|
640
|
|
641 typedef struct ModificationInfo ModificationInfo;
|
|
642 struct ModificationInfo /* for replying to class 'KAHL', event 'MOD ', keyDirectObject typeAEList*/
|
|
643 {
|
|
644 FSSpec theFile; // identifies the file
|
|
645 long theDate; // the date/time the file was last modified
|
|
646 short saved; // set this to zero when replying, unused
|
|
647 };
|
|
648
|
9
|
649 pascal OSErr
|
593
|
650 Handle_KAHL_MOD_AE(
|
|
651 const AppleEvent *theAEvent,
|
|
652 AppleEvent *theReply,
|
|
653 long refCon)
|
7
|
654 {
|
|
655 OSErr error = noErr;
|
|
656 AEDescList replyList;
|
|
657 long numFiles;
|
|
658 ModificationInfo theFile;
|
|
659 buf_T *buf;
|
|
660
|
|
661 theFile.saved = 0;
|
|
662
|
9
|
663 error = HandleUnusedParms(theAEvent);
|
7
|
664 if (error)
|
1107
|
665 return error;
|
7
|
666
|
|
667 /* Send the reply */
|
|
668 /* replyObject.descriptorType = typeNull;
|
|
669 replyObject.dataHandle = nil;*/
|
|
670
|
|
671 /* AECreateDesc(typeChar, (Ptr)&title[1], title[0], &data) */
|
|
672 error = AECreateList(nil, 0, false, &replyList);
|
|
673 if (error)
|
1107
|
674 return error;
|
7
|
675
|
|
676 #if 0
|
|
677 error = AECountItems(&replyList, &numFiles);
|
9
|
678
|
|
679 /* AEPutKeyDesc(&replyList, keyAEPnject, &aDesc)
|
|
680 * AEPutKeyPtr(&replyList, keyAEPosition, typeChar, (Ptr)&theType,
|
7
|
681 * sizeof(DescType))
|
|
682 */
|
|
683
|
|
684 /* AEPutDesc */
|
|
685 #endif
|
|
686
|
|
687 numFiles = 0;
|
|
688 for (buf = firstbuf; buf != NULL; buf = buf->b_next)
|
|
689 if (buf->b_ml.ml_mfp != NULL)
|
|
690 {
|
|
691 /* Add this file to the list */
|
|
692 theFile.theFile = buf->b_FSSpec;
|
|
693 theFile.theDate = buf->b_mtime;
|
9
|
694 /* theFile.theDate = time(NULL) & (time_t) 0xFFFFFFF0; */
|
|
695 error = AEPutPtr(&replyList, numFiles, typeChar, (Ptr) &theFile, sizeof(theFile));
|
7
|
696 };
|
|
697
|
|
698 #if 0
|
|
699 error = AECountItems(&replyList, &numFiles);
|
|
700 #endif
|
|
701
|
|
702 /* We can add data only if something to reply */
|
9
|
703 error = AEPutParamDesc(theReply, keyDirectObject, &replyList);
|
7
|
704
|
|
705 if (replyList.dataHandle)
|
|
706 AEDisposeDesc(&replyList);
|
|
707
|
|
708 return error;
|
|
709 };
|
|
710
|
|
711 /*
|
|
712 * Handle the Get Text event from CodeWarrior
|
|
713 *
|
|
714 * Description
|
|
715 * -----------
|
|
716 *
|
|
717 * The IDE sends the Get Text AppleEvent to the editor when it needs
|
|
718 * the source code from a file. For example, when the user issues a
|
|
719 * Check Syntax or Compile command, the compiler needs access to
|
|
720 * the source code contained in the file.
|
|
721 *
|
|
722 * Event Reply
|
|
723 * -----------
|
|
724 *
|
|
725 * None. Put data in locations specified in the structure received.
|
|
726 *
|
|
727 * Remarks
|
|
728 * -------
|
|
729 *
|
|
730 * When the editor receives this event, it must set the size of the handle
|
|
731 * in theText to fit the data in the file. It must then copy the entire
|
|
732 * contents of the specified file into the memory location specified in
|
|
733 * theText.
|
|
734 *
|
|
735 */
|
|
736
|
|
737 typedef struct CW_GetText CW_GetText;
|
|
738 struct CW_GetText /* for handling class 'KAHL', event 'GTTX', keyDirectObject typeChar*/
|
|
739 {
|
|
740 FSSpec theFile; /* identifies the file */
|
|
741 Handle theText; /* the location where you return the text (must be resized properly) */
|
|
742 long *unused; /* 0 (not used) */
|
|
743 long *theDate; /* where to put the modification date/time */
|
|
744 };
|
|
745
|
9
|
746 pascal OSErr
|
593
|
747 Handle_KAHL_GTTX_AE(
|
|
748 const AppleEvent *theAEvent,
|
|
749 AppleEvent *theReply,
|
|
750 long refCon)
|
7
|
751 {
|
|
752 OSErr error = noErr;
|
|
753 buf_T *buf;
|
|
754 int foundFile = false;
|
|
755 DescType typeCode;
|
|
756 CW_GetText GetTextData;
|
|
757 Size actualSize;
|
|
758 char_u *line;
|
|
759 char_u *fullbuffer = NULL;
|
|
760 long linesize;
|
|
761 long lineStart;
|
|
762 long BufferSize;
|
|
763 long lineno;
|
|
764
|
|
765 error = AEGetParamPtr(theAEvent, keyDirectObject, typeChar, &typeCode, (Ptr) &GetTextData, sizeof(GetTextData), &actualSize);
|
|
766
|
|
767 if (error)
|
1107
|
768 return error;
|
7
|
769
|
|
770 for (buf = firstbuf; buf != NULL; buf = buf->b_next)
|
|
771 if (buf->b_ml.ml_mfp != NULL)
|
|
772 if (GetTextData.theFile.parID == buf->b_FSSpec.parID)
|
|
773 {
|
|
774 foundFile = true;
|
|
775 break;
|
|
776 }
|
|
777
|
|
778 if (foundFile)
|
|
779 {
|
9
|
780 BufferSize = 0; /* GetHandleSize(GetTextData.theText); */
|
7
|
781 for (lineno = 0; lineno <= buf->b_ml.ml_line_count; lineno++)
|
|
782 {
|
|
783 /* Must use the right buffer */
|
|
784 line = ml_get_buf(buf, (linenr_T) lineno, FALSE);
|
|
785 linesize = STRLEN(line) + 1;
|
|
786 lineStart = BufferSize;
|
|
787 BufferSize += linesize;
|
|
788 /* Resize handle to linesize+1 to include the linefeed */
|
9
|
789 SetHandleSize(GetTextData.theText, BufferSize);
|
|
790 if (GetHandleSize(GetTextData.theText) != BufferSize)
|
7
|
791 {
|
|
792 break; /* Simple handling for now */
|
|
793 }
|
|
794 else
|
|
795 {
|
9
|
796 HLock(GetTextData.theText);
|
7
|
797 fullbuffer = (char_u *) *GetTextData.theText;
|
9
|
798 STRCPY((char_u *)(fullbuffer + lineStart), line);
|
7
|
799 fullbuffer[BufferSize-1] = '\r';
|
9
|
800 HUnlock(GetTextData.theText);
|
7
|
801 }
|
|
802 }
|
|
803 if (fullbuffer != NULL)
|
|
804 {
|
9
|
805 HLock(GetTextData.theText);
|
7
|
806 fullbuffer[BufferSize-1] = 0;
|
9
|
807 HUnlock(GetTextData.theText);
|
7
|
808 }
|
|
809 if (foundFile == false)
|
|
810 *GetTextData.theDate = fnfErr;
|
|
811 else
|
9
|
812 /* *GetTextData.theDate = time(NULL) & (time_t) 0xFFFFFFF0;*/
|
7
|
813 *GetTextData.theDate = buf->b_mtime;
|
|
814 }
|
9
|
815
|
|
816 error = HandleUnusedParms(theAEvent);
|
1107
|
817
|
|
818 return error;
|
7
|
819 }
|
|
820
|
|
821 /*
|
|
822 *
|
|
823 */
|
|
824
|
|
825 /* Taken from MoreAppleEvents:ProcessHelpers*/
|
593
|
826 pascal OSErr
|
|
827 FindProcessBySignature(
|
|
828 const OSType targetType,
|
|
829 const OSType targetCreator,
|
|
830 ProcessSerialNumberPtr psnPtr)
|
7
|
831 {
|
|
832 OSErr anErr = noErr;
|
|
833 Boolean lookingForProcess = true;
|
|
834
|
|
835 ProcessInfoRec infoRec;
|
|
836
|
9
|
837 infoRec.processInfoLength = sizeof(ProcessInfoRec);
|
7
|
838 infoRec.processName = nil;
|
|
839 infoRec.processAppSpec = nil;
|
|
840
|
|
841 psnPtr->lowLongOfPSN = kNoProcess;
|
|
842 psnPtr->highLongOfPSN = kNoProcess;
|
|
843
|
9
|
844 while (lookingForProcess)
|
7
|
845 {
|
9
|
846 anErr = GetNextProcess(psnPtr);
|
|
847 if (anErr != noErr)
|
7
|
848 lookingForProcess = false;
|
|
849 else
|
|
850 {
|
9
|
851 anErr = GetProcessInformation(psnPtr, &infoRec);
|
|
852 if ((anErr == noErr)
|
|
853 && (infoRec.processType == targetType)
|
|
854 && (infoRec.processSignature == targetCreator))
|
7
|
855 lookingForProcess = false;
|
|
856 }
|
|
857 }
|
|
858
|
|
859 return anErr;
|
|
860 }//end FindProcessBySignature
|
|
861
|
9
|
862 void
|
|
863 Send_KAHL_MOD_AE(buf_T *buf)
|
7
|
864 {
|
9
|
865 OSErr anErr = noErr;
|
|
866 AEDesc targetAppDesc = { typeNull, nil };
|
7
|
867 ProcessSerialNumber psn = { kNoProcess, kNoProcess };
|
|
868 AppleEvent theReply = { typeNull, nil };
|
|
869 AESendMode sendMode;
|
|
870 AppleEvent theEvent = {typeNull, nil };
|
|
871 AEIdleUPP idleProcUPP = nil;
|
|
872 ModificationInfo ModData;
|
|
873
|
|
874
|
9
|
875 anErr = FindProcessBySignature('APPL', 'CWIE', &psn);
|
|
876 if (anErr == noErr)
|
7
|
877 {
|
9
|
878 anErr = AECreateDesc(typeProcessSerialNumber, &psn,
|
|
879 sizeof(ProcessSerialNumber), &targetAppDesc);
|
|
880
|
|
881 if (anErr == noErr)
|
7
|
882 {
|
|
883 anErr = AECreateAppleEvent( 'KAHL', 'MOD ', &targetAppDesc,
|
|
884 kAutoGenerateReturnID, kAnyTransactionID, &theEvent);
|
|
885 }
|
|
886
|
9
|
887 AEDisposeDesc(&targetAppDesc);
|
7
|
888
|
|
889 /* Add the parms */
|
|
890 ModData.theFile = buf->b_FSSpec;
|
|
891 ModData.theDate = buf->b_mtime;
|
|
892
|
|
893 if (anErr == noErr)
|
9
|
894 anErr = AEPutParamPtr(&theEvent, keyDirectObject, typeChar, &ModData, sizeof(ModData));
|
|
895
|
|
896 if (idleProcUPP == nil)
|
7
|
897 sendMode = kAENoReply;
|
|
898 else
|
|
899 sendMode = kAEWaitReply;
|
|
900
|
9
|
901 if (anErr == noErr)
|
|
902 anErr = AESend(&theEvent, &theReply, sendMode, kAENormalPriority, kNoTimeOut, idleProcUPP, nil);
|
|
903 if (anErr == noErr && sendMode == kAEWaitReply)
|
7
|
904 {
|
9
|
905 /* anErr = AEHGetHandlerError(&theReply);*/
|
7
|
906 }
|
9
|
907 (void) AEDisposeDesc(&theReply);
|
7
|
908 }
|
|
909 }
|
|
910 #endif /* FEAT_CW_EDITOR */
|
|
911
|
|
912 /*
|
|
913 * ------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
914 * Apple Event Handling procedure
|
|
915 * ------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
916 */
|
|
917 #ifdef USE_AEVENT
|
|
918
|
|
919 /*
|
|
920 * Handle the Unused parms of an AppleEvent
|
|
921 */
|
|
922
|
9
|
923 OSErr
|
|
924 HandleUnusedParms(const AppleEvent *theAEvent)
|
7
|
925 {
|
|
926 OSErr error;
|
|
927 long actualSize;
|
|
928 DescType dummyType;
|
|
929 AEKeyword missedKeyword;
|
|
930
|
|
931 /* Get the "missed keyword" attribute from the AppleEvent. */
|
|
932 error = AEGetAttributePtr(theAEvent, keyMissedKeywordAttr,
|
|
933 typeKeyword, &dummyType,
|
|
934 (Ptr)&missedKeyword, sizeof(missedKeyword),
|
|
935 &actualSize);
|
|
936
|
|
937 /* If the descriptor isn't found, then we got the required parameters. */
|
|
938 if (error == errAEDescNotFound)
|
|
939 {
|
|
940 error = noErr;
|
|
941 }
|
|
942 else
|
|
943 {
|
|
944 #if 0
|
|
945 /* Why is this removed? */
|
|
946 error = errAEEventNotHandled;
|
|
947 #endif
|
|
948 }
|
|
949
|
|
950 return error;
|
|
951 }
|
|
952
|
|
953
|
|
954 /*
|
|
955 * Handle the ODoc AppleEvent
|
|
956 *
|
|
957 * Deals with all files dragged to the application icon.
|
|
958 *
|
|
959 */
|
|
960
|
|
961 typedef struct SelectionRange SelectionRange;
|
|
962 struct SelectionRange /* for handling kCoreClassEvent:kOpenDocuments:keyAEPosition typeChar */
|
|
963 {
|
|
964 short unused1; // 0 (not used)
|
|
965 short lineNum; // line to select (<0 to specify range)
|
|
966 long startRange; // start of selection range (if line < 0)
|
|
967 long endRange; // end of selection range (if line < 0)
|
|
968 long unused2; // 0 (not used)
|
|
969 long theDate; // modification date/time
|
|
970 };
|
|
971
|
|
972 /* The IDE uses the optional keyAEPosition parameter to tell the ed-
|
|
973 itor the selection range. If lineNum is zero or greater, scroll the text
|
|
974 to the specified line. If lineNum is less than zero, use the values in
|
|
975 startRange and endRange to select the specified characters. Scroll
|
|
976 the text to display the selection. If lineNum, startRange, and
|
|
977 endRange are all negative, there is no selection range specified.
|
|
978 */
|
|
979
|
9
|
980 pascal OSErr
|
|
981 HandleODocAE(const AppleEvent *theAEvent, AppleEvent *theReply, long refCon)
|
7
|
982 {
|
|
983 /*
|
|
984 * TODO: Clean up the code with convert the AppleEvent into
|
|
985 * a ":args"
|
|
986 */
|
|
987 OSErr error = noErr;
|
|
988 // OSErr firstError = noErr;
|
|
989 // short numErrors = 0;
|
|
990 AEDesc theList;
|
|
991 DescType typeCode;
|
|
992 long numFiles;
|
|
993 // long fileCount;
|
|
994 char_u **fnames;
|
|
995 // char_u fname[256];
|
|
996 Size actualSize;
|
|
997 SelectionRange thePosition;
|
|
998 short gotPosition = false;
|
|
999 long lnum;
|
|
1000
|
|
1001 /* the direct object parameter is the list of aliases to files (one or more) */
|
|
1002 error = AEGetParamDesc(theAEvent, keyDirectObject, typeAEList, &theList);
|
|
1003 if (error)
|
1107
|
1004 return error;
|
7
|
1005
|
|
1006
|
|
1007 error = AEGetParamPtr(theAEvent, keyAEPosition, typeChar, &typeCode, (Ptr) &thePosition, sizeof(SelectionRange), &actualSize);
|
|
1008 if (error == noErr)
|
|
1009 gotPosition = true;
|
|
1010 if (error == errAEDescNotFound)
|
|
1011 error = noErr;
|
|
1012 if (error)
|
1107
|
1013 return error;
|
7
|
1014
|
|
1015 /*
|
|
1016 error = AEGetParamDesc(theAEvent, keyAEPosition, typeChar, &thePosition);
|
|
1017
|
|
1018 if (^error) then
|
|
1019 {
|
|
1020 if (thePosition.lineNum >= 0)
|
|
1021 {
|
|
1022 // Goto this line
|
|
1023 }
|
|
1024 else
|
|
1025 {
|
|
1026 // Set the range char wise
|
|
1027 }
|
|
1028 }
|
|
1029 */
|
|
1030
|
|
1031
|
|
1032 #ifdef FEAT_VISUAL
|
|
1033 reset_VIsual();
|
|
1034 #endif
|
|
1035
|
|
1036 fnames = new_fnames_from_AEDesc(&theList, &numFiles, &error);
|
|
1037
|
|
1038 if (error)
|
|
1039 {
|
|
1040 /* TODO: empty fnames[] first */
|
|
1041 vim_free(fnames);
|
|
1042 return (error);
|
|
1043 }
|
|
1044
|
|
1045 if (starting > 0)
|
|
1046 {
|
|
1047 int i;
|
|
1048 char_u *p;
|
|
1049
|
|
1050 /* these are the initial files dropped on the Vim icon */
|
|
1051 for (i = 0 ; i < numFiles; i++)
|
|
1052 {
|
|
1053 if (ga_grow(&global_alist.al_ga, 1) == FAIL
|
|
1054 || (p = vim_strsave(fnames[i])) == NULL)
|
|
1055 mch_exit(2);
|
|
1056 else
|
|
1057 alist_add(&global_alist, p, 2);
|
|
1058 }
|
816
|
1059
|
|
1060 /* Change directory to the location of the first file. */
|
|
1061 if (GARGCOUNT > 0 && vim_chdirfile(alist_name(&GARGLIST[0])) == OK)
|
|
1062 shorten_fnames(TRUE);
|
|
1063
|
7
|
1064 goto finished;
|
|
1065 }
|
|
1066
|
|
1067 /* Handle the drop, :edit to get to the file */
|
|
1068 handle_drop(numFiles, fnames, FALSE);
|
|
1069
|
|
1070 /* TODO: Handle the goto/select line more cleanly */
|
|
1071 if ((numFiles == 1) & (gotPosition))
|
|
1072 {
|
|
1073 if (thePosition.lineNum >= 0)
|
|
1074 {
|
37
|
1075 lnum = thePosition.lineNum + 1;
|
7
|
1076 /* oap->motion_type = MLINE;
|
|
1077 setpcmark();*/
|
|
1078 if (lnum < 1L)
|
|
1079 lnum = 1L;
|
|
1080 else if (lnum > curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count)
|
|
1081 lnum = curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count;
|
|
1082 curwin->w_cursor.lnum = lnum;
|
37
|
1083 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;
|
7
|
1084 /* beginline(BL_SOL | BL_FIX);*/
|
|
1085 }
|
|
1086 else
|
|
1087 goto_byte(thePosition.startRange + 1);
|
|
1088 }
|
|
1089
|
|
1090 /* Update the screen display */
|
|
1091 update_screen(NOT_VALID);
|
37
|
1092 #ifdef FEAT_VISUAL
|
|
1093 /* Select the text if possible */
|
|
1094 if (gotPosition)
|
|
1095 {
|
168
|
1096 VIsual_active = TRUE;
|
|
1097 VIsual_select = FALSE;
|
|
1098 VIsual = curwin->w_cursor;
|
|
1099 if (thePosition.lineNum < 0)
|
37
|
1100 {
|
168
|
1101 VIsual_mode = 'v';
|
|
1102 goto_byte(thePosition.endRange);
|
|
1103 }
|
|
1104 else
|
37
|
1105 {
|
168
|
1106 VIsual_mode = 'V';
|
|
1107 VIsual.col = 0;
|
|
1108 }
|
37
|
1109 }
|
|
1110 #endif
|
7
|
1111 setcursor();
|
|
1112 out_flush();
|
|
1113
|
37
|
1114 /* Fake mouse event to wake from stall */
|
|
1115 PostEvent(mouseUp, 0);
|
|
1116
|
1107
|
1117 finished:
|
7
|
1118 AEDisposeDesc(&theList); /* dispose what we allocated */
|
|
1119
|
9
|
1120 error = HandleUnusedParms(theAEvent);
|
1107
|
1121 return error;
|
7
|
1122 }
|
|
1123
|
|
1124 /*
|
|
1125 *
|
|
1126 */
|
|
1127
|
9
|
1128 pascal OSErr
|
593
|
1129 Handle_aevt_oapp_AE(
|
|
1130 const AppleEvent *theAEvent,
|
|
1131 AppleEvent *theReply,
|
|
1132 long refCon)
|
7
|
1133 {
|
|
1134 OSErr error = noErr;
|
|
1135
|
9
|
1136 error = HandleUnusedParms(theAEvent);
|
1107
|
1137 return error;
|
7
|
1138 }
|
|
1139
|
|
1140 /*
|
|
1141 *
|
|
1142 */
|
|
1143
|
9
|
1144 pascal OSErr
|
593
|
1145 Handle_aevt_quit_AE(
|
|
1146 const AppleEvent *theAEvent,
|
|
1147 AppleEvent *theReply,
|
|
1148 long refCon)
|
7
|
1149 {
|
|
1150 OSErr error = noErr;
|
|
1151
|
9
|
1152 error = HandleUnusedParms(theAEvent);
|
7
|
1153 if (error)
|
1107
|
1154 return error;
|
7
|
1155
|
|
1156 /* Need to fake a :confirm qa */
|
|
1157 do_cmdline_cmd((char_u *)"confirm qa");
|
|
1158
|
1107
|
1159 return error;
|
7
|
1160 }
|
|
1161
|
|
1162 /*
|
|
1163 *
|
|
1164 */
|
|
1165
|
9
|
1166 pascal OSErr
|
593
|
1167 Handle_aevt_pdoc_AE(
|
|
1168 const AppleEvent *theAEvent,
|
|
1169 AppleEvent *theReply,
|
|
1170 long refCon)
|
7
|
1171 {
|
|
1172 OSErr error = noErr;
|
|
1173
|
9
|
1174 error = HandleUnusedParms(theAEvent);
|
1107
|
1175
|
|
1176 return error;
|
7
|
1177 }
|
|
1178
|
|
1179 /*
|
|
1180 * Handling of unknown AppleEvent
|
|
1181 *
|
|
1182 * (Just get rid of all the parms)
|
|
1183 */
|
9
|
1184 pascal OSErr
|
593
|
1185 Handle_unknown_AE(
|
|
1186 const AppleEvent *theAEvent,
|
|
1187 AppleEvent *theReply,
|
|
1188 long refCon)
|
7
|
1189 {
|
|
1190 OSErr error = noErr;
|
|
1191
|
9
|
1192 error = HandleUnusedParms(theAEvent);
|
1107
|
1193
|
|
1194 return error;
|
7
|
1195 }
|
|
1196
|
|
1197
|
|
1198 /*
|
|
1199 * Install the various AppleEvent Handlers
|
|
1200 */
|
9
|
1201 OSErr
|
|
1202 InstallAEHandlers(void)
|
7
|
1203 {
|
|
1204 OSErr error;
|
|
1205
|
|
1206 /* install open application handler */
|
|
1207 error = AEInstallEventHandler(kCoreEventClass, kAEOpenApplication,
|
593
|
1208 NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_aevt_oapp_AE), 0, false);
|
7
|
1209 if (error)
|
|
1210 {
|
|
1211 return error;
|
|
1212 }
|
|
1213
|
|
1214 /* install quit application handler */
|
|
1215 error = AEInstallEventHandler(kCoreEventClass, kAEQuitApplication,
|
593
|
1216 NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_aevt_quit_AE), 0, false);
|
7
|
1217 if (error)
|
|
1218 {
|
|
1219 return error;
|
|
1220 }
|
|
1221
|
|
1222 /* install open document handler */
|
|
1223 error = AEInstallEventHandler(kCoreEventClass, kAEOpenDocuments,
|
593
|
1224 NewAEEventHandlerUPP(HandleODocAE), 0, false);
|
7
|
1225 if (error)
|
|
1226 {
|
|
1227 return error;
|
|
1228 }
|
|
1229
|
|
1230 /* install print document handler */
|
|
1231 error = AEInstallEventHandler(kCoreEventClass, kAEPrintDocuments,
|
593
|
1232 NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_aevt_pdoc_AE), 0, false);
|
7
|
1233
|
|
1234 /* Install Core Suite */
|
|
1235 /* error = AEInstallEventHandler(kAECoreSuite, kAEClone,
|
593
|
1236 NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_unknown_AE), nil, false);
|
7
|
1237
|
|
1238 error = AEInstallEventHandler(kAECoreSuite, kAEClose,
|
593
|
1239 NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_unknown_AE), nil, false);
|
7
|
1240
|
|
1241 error = AEInstallEventHandler(kAECoreSuite, kAECountElements,
|
593
|
1242 NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_unknown_AE), nil, false);
|
7
|
1243
|
|
1244 error = AEInstallEventHandler(kAECoreSuite, kAECreateElement,
|
593
|
1245 NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_unknown_AE), nil, false);
|
7
|
1246
|
|
1247 error = AEInstallEventHandler(kAECoreSuite, kAEDelete,
|
593
|
1248 NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_unknown_AE), nil, false);
|
7
|
1249
|
|
1250 error = AEInstallEventHandler(kAECoreSuite, kAEDoObjectsExist,
|
593
|
1251 NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_unknown_AE), nil, false);
|
7
|
1252
|
|
1253 error = AEInstallEventHandler(kAECoreSuite, kAEGetData,
|
593
|
1254 NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_unknown_AE), kAEGetData, false);
|
7
|
1255
|
|
1256 error = AEInstallEventHandler(kAECoreSuite, kAEGetDataSize,
|
593
|
1257 NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_unknown_AE), kAEGetDataSize, false);
|
7
|
1258
|
|
1259 error = AEInstallEventHandler(kAECoreSuite, kAEGetClassInfo,
|
593
|
1260 NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_unknown_AE), nil, false);
|
7
|
1261
|
|
1262 error = AEInstallEventHandler(kAECoreSuite, kAEGetEventInfo,
|
593
|
1263 NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_unknown_AE), nil, false);
|
7
|
1264
|
|
1265 error = AEInstallEventHandler(kAECoreSuite, kAEMove,
|
593
|
1266 NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_unknown_AE), nil, false);
|
7
|
1267
|
|
1268 error = AEInstallEventHandler(kAECoreSuite, kAESave,
|
593
|
1269 NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_unknown_AE), nil, false);
|
7
|
1270
|
|
1271 error = AEInstallEventHandler(kAECoreSuite, kAESetData,
|
593
|
1272 NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_unknown_AE), nil, false);
|
7
|
1273 */
|
|
1274
|
|
1275 #ifdef FEAT_CW_EDITOR
|
|
1276 /*
|
|
1277 * Bind codewarrior support handlers
|
|
1278 */
|
|
1279 error = AEInstallEventHandler('KAHL', 'GTTX',
|
593
|
1280 NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_KAHL_GTTX_AE), 0, false);
|
7
|
1281 if (error)
|
|
1282 {
|
|
1283 return error;
|
|
1284 }
|
|
1285 error = AEInstallEventHandler('KAHL', 'SRCH',
|
593
|
1286 NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_KAHL_SRCH_AE), 0, false);
|
7
|
1287 if (error)
|
|
1288 {
|
|
1289 return error;
|
|
1290 }
|
|
1291 error = AEInstallEventHandler('KAHL', 'MOD ',
|
593
|
1292 NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_KAHL_MOD_AE), 0, false);
|
7
|
1293 if (error)
|
|
1294 {
|
|
1295 return error;
|
|
1296 }
|
|
1297 #endif
|
|
1298
|
|
1299 return error;
|
|
1300
|
|
1301 }
|
|
1302 #endif /* USE_AEVENT */
|
|
1303
|
13
|
1304
|
|
1305 /*
|
|
1306 * Callback function, installed by InstallFontPanelHandler(), below,
|
|
1307 * to handle Font Panel events.
|
|
1308 */
|
|
1309 static OSStatus
|
593
|
1310 FontPanelHandler(
|
|
1311 EventHandlerCallRef inHandlerCallRef,
|
|
1312 EventRef inEvent,
|
|
1313 void *inUserData)
|
13
|
1314 {
|
|
1315 if (GetEventKind(inEvent) == kEventFontPanelClosed)
|
|
1316 {
|
|
1317 gFontPanelInfo.isPanelVisible = false;
|
|
1318 return noErr;
|
|
1319 }
|
|
1320
|
|
1321 if (GetEventKind(inEvent) == kEventFontSelection)
|
|
1322 {
|
|
1323 OSStatus status;
|
|
1324 FMFontFamily newFamily;
|
|
1325 FMFontSize newSize;
|
|
1326 FMFontStyle newStyle;
|
|
1327
|
|
1328 /* Retrieve the font family ID number. */
|
|
1329 status = GetEventParameter(inEvent, kEventParamFMFontFamily,
|
|
1330 /*inDesiredType=*/typeFMFontFamily, /*outActualType=*/NULL,
|
|
1331 /*inBufferSize=*/sizeof(FMFontFamily), /*outActualSize=*/NULL,
|
|
1332 &newFamily);
|
|
1333 if (status == noErr)
|
|
1334 gFontPanelInfo.family = newFamily;
|
|
1335
|
|
1336 /* Retrieve the font size. */
|
|
1337 status = GetEventParameter(inEvent, kEventParamFMFontSize,
|
|
1338 typeFMFontSize, NULL, sizeof(FMFontSize), NULL, &newSize);
|
|
1339 if (status == noErr)
|
|
1340 gFontPanelInfo.size = newSize;
|
|
1341
|
|
1342 /* Retrieve the font style (bold, etc.). Currently unused. */
|
|
1343 status = GetEventParameter(inEvent, kEventParamFMFontStyle,
|
|
1344 typeFMFontStyle, NULL, sizeof(FMFontStyle), NULL, &newStyle);
|
|
1345 if (status == noErr)
|
|
1346 gFontPanelInfo.style = newStyle;
|
|
1347 }
|
|
1348 return noErr;
|
|
1349 }
|
|
1350
|
|
1351
|
|
1352 static void
|
593
|
1353 InstallFontPanelHandler(void)
|
13
|
1354 {
|
|
1355 EventTypeSpec eventTypes[2];
|
|
1356 EventHandlerUPP handlerUPP;
|
|
1357 /* EventHandlerRef handlerRef; */
|
|
1358
|
|
1359 eventTypes[0].eventClass = kEventClassFont;
|
|
1360 eventTypes[0].eventKind = kEventFontSelection;
|
|
1361 eventTypes[1].eventClass = kEventClassFont;
|
|
1362 eventTypes[1].eventKind = kEventFontPanelClosed;
|
|
1363
|
|
1364 handlerUPP = NewEventHandlerUPP(FontPanelHandler);
|
|
1365
|
|
1366 InstallApplicationEventHandler(handlerUPP, /*numTypes=*/2, eventTypes,
|
|
1367 /*userData=*/NULL, /*handlerRef=*/NULL);
|
|
1368 }
|
|
1369
|
|
1370
|
|
1371 /*
|
|
1372 * Fill the buffer pointed to by outName with the name and size
|
|
1373 * of the font currently selected in the Font Panel.
|
|
1374 */
|
168
|
1375 #define FONT_STYLE_BUFFER_SIZE 32
|
13
|
1376 static void
|
501
|
1377 GetFontPanelSelection(char_u *outName)
|
13
|
1378 {
|
168
|
1379 Str255 buf;
|
|
1380 ByteCount fontNameLen = 0;
|
|
1381 ATSUFontID fid;
|
|
1382 char_u styleString[FONT_STYLE_BUFFER_SIZE];
|
13
|
1383
|
|
1384 if (!outName)
|
|
1385 return;
|
|
1386
|
168
|
1387 if (FMGetFontFamilyName(gFontPanelInfo.family, buf) == noErr)
|
|
1388 {
|
|
1389 /* Canonicalize localized font names */
|
|
1390 if (FMGetFontFromFontFamilyInstance(gFontPanelInfo.family,
|
|
1391 gFontPanelInfo.style, &fid, NULL) != noErr)
|
|
1392 return;
|
|
1393
|
|
1394 /* Request font name with Mac encoding (otherwise we could
|
|
1395 * get an unwanted utf-16 name) */
|
|
1396 if (ATSUFindFontName(fid, kFontFullName, kFontMacintoshPlatform,
|
|
1397 kFontNoScriptCode, kFontNoLanguageCode,
|
501
|
1398 255, (char *)outName, &fontNameLen, NULL) != noErr)
|
168
|
1399 return;
|
|
1400
|
|
1401 /* Only encode font size, because style (bold, italic, etc) is
|
|
1402 * already part of the font full name */
|
501
|
1403 vim_snprintf((char *)styleString, FONT_STYLE_BUFFER_SIZE, ":h%d",
|
168
|
1404 gFontPanelInfo.size/*,
|
|
1405 ((gFontPanelInfo.style & bold)!=0 ? ":b" : ""),
|
|
1406 ((gFontPanelInfo.style & italic)!=0 ? ":i" : ""),
|
|
1407 ((gFontPanelInfo.style & underline)!=0 ? ":u" : "")*/);
|
|
1408
|
|
1409 if ((fontNameLen + STRLEN(styleString)) < 255)
|
|
1410 STRCPY(outName + fontNameLen, styleString);
|
|
1411 }
|
|
1412 else
|
|
1413 {
|
501
|
1414 *outName = NUL;
|
168
|
1415 }
|
13
|
1416 }
|
|
1417
|
|
1418
|
7
|
1419 /*
|
|
1420 * ------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
1421 * Unfiled yet
|
|
1422 * ------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
1423 */
|
|
1424
|
|
1425 /*
|
|
1426 * gui_mac_get_menu_item_index
|
|
1427 *
|
|
1428 * Returns the index inside the menu wher
|
|
1429 */
|
|
1430 short /* Shoulde we return MenuItemIndex? */
|
593
|
1431 gui_mac_get_menu_item_index(vimmenu_T *pMenu)
|
7
|
1432 {
|
|
1433 short index;
|
|
1434 short itemIndex = -1;
|
|
1435 vimmenu_T *pBrother;
|
|
1436
|
|
1437 /* Only menu without parent are the:
|
|
1438 * -menu in the menubar
|
|
1439 * -popup menu
|
|
1440 * -toolbar (guess)
|
|
1441 *
|
|
1442 * Which are not items anyway.
|
|
1443 */
|
|
1444 if (pMenu->parent)
|
|
1445 {
|
|
1446 /* Start from the Oldest Brother */
|
|
1447 pBrother = pMenu->parent->children;
|
|
1448 index = 1;
|
|
1449 while ((pBrother) && (itemIndex == -1))
|
|
1450 {
|
|
1451 if (pBrother == pMenu)
|
|
1452 itemIndex = index;
|
|
1453 index++;
|
|
1454 pBrother = pBrother->next;
|
|
1455 }
|
|
1456 }
|
|
1457 return itemIndex;
|
|
1458 }
|
|
1459
|
|
1460 static vimmenu_T *
|
593
|
1461 gui_mac_get_vim_menu(short menuID, short itemIndex, vimmenu_T *pMenu)
|
7
|
1462 {
|
|
1463 short index;
|
|
1464 vimmenu_T *pChildMenu;
|
|
1465 vimmenu_T *pElder = pMenu->parent;
|
|
1466
|
|
1467
|
|
1468 /* Only menu without parent are the:
|
|
1469 * -menu in the menubar
|
|
1470 * -popup menu
|
|
1471 * -toolbar (guess)
|
|
1472 *
|
|
1473 * Which are not items anyway.
|
|
1474 */
|
|
1475
|
|
1476 if ((pElder) && (pElder->submenu_id == menuID))
|
|
1477 {
|
|
1478 for (index = 1; (index != itemIndex) && (pMenu != NULL); index++)
|
|
1479 pMenu = pMenu->next;
|
|
1480 }
|
|
1481 else
|
|
1482 {
|
|
1483 for (; pMenu != NULL; pMenu = pMenu->next)
|
|
1484 {
|
|
1485 if (pMenu->children != NULL)
|
|
1486 {
|
|
1487 pChildMenu = gui_mac_get_vim_menu
|
|
1488 (menuID, itemIndex, pMenu->children);
|
|
1489 if (pChildMenu)
|
|
1490 {
|
|
1491 pMenu = pChildMenu;
|
|
1492 break;
|
|
1493 }
|
|
1494 }
|
|
1495 }
|
|
1496 }
|
|
1497 return pMenu;
|
|
1498 }
|
|
1499
|
|
1500 /*
|
|
1501 * ------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
1502 * MacOS Feedback procedures
|
|
1503 * ------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
1504 */
|
|
1505 pascal
|
|
1506 void
|
9
|
1507 gui_mac_drag_thumb(ControlHandle theControl, short partCode)
|
7
|
1508 {
|
|
1509 scrollbar_T *sb;
|
|
1510 int value, dragging;
|
|
1511 ControlHandle theControlToUse;
|
|
1512 int dont_scroll_save = dont_scroll;
|
|
1513
|
|
1514 theControlToUse = dragged_sb;
|
|
1515
|
9
|
1516 sb = gui_find_scrollbar((long) GetControlReference(theControlToUse));
|
7
|
1517
|
|
1518 if (sb == NULL)
|
|
1519 return;
|
|
1520
|
|
1521 /* Need to find value by diff between Old Poss New Pos */
|
9
|
1522 value = GetControl32BitValue(theControlToUse);
|
7
|
1523 dragging = (partCode != 0);
|
|
1524
|
|
1525 /* When "allow_scrollbar" is FALSE still need to remember the new
|
|
1526 * position, but don't actually scroll by setting "dont_scroll". */
|
|
1527 dont_scroll = !allow_scrollbar;
|
|
1528 gui_drag_scrollbar(sb, value, dragging);
|
|
1529 dont_scroll = dont_scroll_save;
|
|
1530 }
|
|
1531
|
|
1532 pascal
|
|
1533 void
|
9
|
1534 gui_mac_scroll_action(ControlHandle theControl, short partCode)
|
7
|
1535 {
|
|
1536 /* TODO: have live support */
|
|
1537 scrollbar_T *sb, *sb_info;
|
|
1538 long data;
|
|
1539 long value;
|
|
1540 int page;
|
|
1541 int dragging = FALSE;
|
|
1542 int dont_scroll_save = dont_scroll;
|
|
1543
|
9
|
1544 sb = gui_find_scrollbar((long)GetControlReference(theControl));
|
7
|
1545
|
|
1546 if (sb == NULL)
|
|
1547 return;
|
|
1548
|
|
1549 if (sb->wp != NULL) /* Left or right scrollbar */
|
|
1550 {
|
|
1551 /*
|
|
1552 * Careful: need to get scrollbar info out of first (left) scrollbar
|
|
1553 * for window, but keep real scrollbar too because we must pass it to
|
|
1554 * gui_drag_scrollbar().
|
|
1555 */
|
|
1556 sb_info = &sb->wp->w_scrollbars[0];
|
|
1557
|
|
1558 if (sb_info->size > 5)
|
|
1559 page = sb_info->size - 2; /* use two lines of context */
|
|
1560 else
|
|
1561 page = sb_info->size;
|
|
1562 }
|
|
1563 else /* Bottom scrollbar */
|
|
1564 {
|
|
1565 sb_info = sb;
|
|
1566 page = W_WIDTH(curwin) - 5;
|
|
1567 }
|
|
1568
|
|
1569 switch (partCode)
|
|
1570 {
|
|
1571 case kControlUpButtonPart: data = -1; break;
|
|
1572 case kControlDownButtonPart: data = 1; break;
|
|
1573 case kControlPageDownPart: data = page; break;
|
|
1574 case kControlPageUpPart: data = -page; break;
|
|
1575 default: data = 0; break;
|
|
1576 }
|
|
1577
|
|
1578 value = sb_info->value + data;
|
|
1579 /* if (value > sb_info->max)
|
|
1580 value = sb_info->max;
|
|
1581 else if (value < 0)
|
|
1582 value = 0;*/
|
|
1583
|
|
1584 /* When "allow_scrollbar" is FALSE still need to remember the new
|
|
1585 * position, but don't actually scroll by setting "dont_scroll". */
|
|
1586 dont_scroll = !allow_scrollbar;
|
|
1587 gui_drag_scrollbar(sb, value, dragging);
|
|
1588 dont_scroll = dont_scroll_save;
|
|
1589
|
|
1590 out_flush();
|
|
1591 gui_mch_set_scrollbar_thumb(sb, value, sb_info->size, sb_info->max);
|
|
1592
|
|
1593 /* if (sb_info->wp != NULL)
|
|
1594 {
|
|
1595 win_T *wp;
|
|
1596 int sb_num;
|
|
1597
|
|
1598 sb_num = 0;
|
|
1599 for (wp = firstwin; wp != sb->wp && wp != NULL; wp = W_NEXT(wp))
|
|
1600 sb_num++;
|
|
1601
|
|
1602 if (wp != NULL)
|
|
1603 {
|
|
1604 current_scrollbar = sb_num;
|
|
1605 scrollbar_value = value;
|
|
1606 gui_do_scroll();
|
|
1607 gui_mch_set_scrollbar_thumb(sb, value, sb_info->size, sb_info->max);
|
|
1608 }
|
|
1609 }*/
|
|
1610 }
|
|
1611
|
|
1612 /*
|
|
1613 * ------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
1614 * MacOS Click Handling procedures
|
|
1615 * ------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
1616 */
|
|
1617
|
|
1618
|
|
1619 /*
|
|
1620 * Handle a click inside the window, it may happens in the
|
|
1621 * scrollbar or the contents.
|
|
1622 *
|
|
1623 * TODO: Add support for potential TOOLBAR
|
|
1624 */
|
|
1625 void
|
593
|
1626 gui_mac_doInContentClick(EventRecord *theEvent, WindowPtr whichWindow)
|
7
|
1627 {
|
|
1628 Point thePoint;
|
|
1629 int_u vimModifiers;
|
|
1630 short thePortion;
|
|
1631 ControlHandle theControl;
|
|
1632 int vimMouseButton;
|
|
1633 short dblClick;
|
|
1634
|
|
1635 thePoint = theEvent->where;
|
9
|
1636 GlobalToLocal(&thePoint);
|
|
1637 SelectWindow(whichWindow);
|
|
1638
|
|
1639 thePortion = FindControl(thePoint, whichWindow, &theControl);
|
7
|
1640
|
|
1641 if (theControl != NUL)
|
|
1642 {
|
|
1643 /* We hit a scollbar */
|
|
1644
|
|
1645 if (thePortion != kControlIndicatorPart)
|
|
1646 {
|
|
1647 dragged_sb = theControl;
|
|
1648 TrackControl(theControl, thePoint, gScrollAction);
|
|
1649 dragged_sb = NULL;
|
|
1650 }
|
|
1651 else
|
|
1652 {
|
|
1653 dragged_sb = theControl;
|
|
1654 #if 1
|
|
1655 TrackControl(theControl, thePoint, gScrollDrag);
|
|
1656 #else
|
|
1657 TrackControl(theControl, thePoint, NULL);
|
|
1658 #endif
|
|
1659 /* pass 0 as the part to tell gui_mac_drag_thumb, that the mouse
|
|
1660 * button has been released */
|
9
|
1661 gui_mac_drag_thumb(theControl, 0); /* Should it be thePortion ? (Dany) */
|
7
|
1662 dragged_sb = NULL;
|
|
1663 }
|
|
1664 }
|
|
1665 else
|
|
1666 {
|
|
1667 /* We are inside the contents */
|
|
1668
|
|
1669 /* Convert the CTRL, OPTION, SHIFT and CMD key */
|
|
1670 vimModifiers = EventModifiers2VimMouseModifiers(theEvent->modifiers);
|
|
1671
|
|
1672 /* Defaults to MOUSE_LEFT as there's only one mouse button */
|
|
1673 vimMouseButton = MOUSE_LEFT;
|
|
1674
|
|
1675 /* Convert the CTRL_MOUSE_LEFT to MOUSE_RIGHT */
|
593
|
1676 /* TODO: NEEDED? */
|
7
|
1677 clickIsPopup = FALSE;
|
|
1678
|
|
1679 if ((gui.MacOSHaveCntxMenu) && (mouse_model_popup()))
|
|
1680 if (IsShowContextualMenuClick(theEvent))
|
|
1681 {
|
|
1682 vimMouseButton = MOUSE_RIGHT;
|
|
1683 vimModifiers &= ~MOUSE_CTRL;
|
|
1684 clickIsPopup = TRUE;
|
|
1685 }
|
|
1686
|
|
1687 /* Is it a double click ? */
|
|
1688 dblClick = ((theEvent->when - lastMouseTick) < GetDblTime());
|
|
1689
|
593
|
1690 /* Send the mouse click to Vim */
|
7
|
1691 gui_send_mouse_event(vimMouseButton, thePoint.h,
|
|
1692 thePoint.v, dblClick, vimModifiers);
|
|
1693
|
|
1694 /* Create the rectangle around the cursor to detect
|
|
1695 * the mouse dragging
|
|
1696 */
|
|
1697 #if 0
|
|
1698 /* TODO: Do we need to this even for the contextual menu?
|
|
1699 * It may be require for popup_setpos, but for popup?
|
|
1700 */
|
|
1701 if (vimMouseButton == MOUSE_LEFT)
|
|
1702 #endif
|
|
1703 {
|
9
|
1704 SetRect(&dragRect, FILL_X(X_2_COL(thePoint.h)),
|
7
|
1705 FILL_Y(Y_2_ROW(thePoint.v)),
|
|
1706 FILL_X(X_2_COL(thePoint.h)+1),
|
|
1707 FILL_Y(Y_2_ROW(thePoint.v)+1));
|
|
1708
|
|
1709 dragRectEnbl = TRUE;
|
|
1710 dragRectControl = kCreateRect;
|
|
1711 }
|
|
1712 }
|
|
1713 }
|
|
1714
|
|
1715 /*
|
|
1716 * Handle the click in the titlebar (to move the window)
|
|
1717 */
|
|
1718 void
|
593
|
1719 gui_mac_doInDragClick(Point where, WindowPtr whichWindow)
|
7
|
1720 {
|
|
1721 Rect movingLimits;
|
|
1722 Rect *movingLimitsPtr = &movingLimits;
|
|
1723
|
|
1724 /* TODO: may try to prevent move outside screen? */
|
9
|
1725 movingLimitsPtr = GetRegionBounds(GetGrayRgn(), &movingLimits);
|
|
1726 DragWindow(whichWindow, where, movingLimitsPtr);
|
7
|
1727 }
|
|
1728
|
|
1729 /*
|
|
1730 * Handle the click in the grow box
|
|
1731 */
|
|
1732 void
|
593
|
1733 gui_mac_doInGrowClick(Point where, WindowPtr whichWindow)
|
7
|
1734 {
|
|
1735
|
|
1736 long newSize;
|
|
1737 unsigned short newWidth;
|
|
1738 unsigned short newHeight;
|
|
1739 Rect resizeLimits;
|
|
1740 Rect *resizeLimitsPtr = &resizeLimits;
|
|
1741 Rect NewContentRect;
|
|
1742
|
9
|
1743 resizeLimitsPtr = GetRegionBounds(GetGrayRgn(), &resizeLimits);
|
7
|
1744
|
|
1745 /* Set the minimun size */
|
|
1746 /* TODO: Should this come from Vim? */
|
|
1747 resizeLimits.top = 100;
|
|
1748 resizeLimits.left = 100;
|
|
1749
|
|
1750 newSize = ResizeWindow(whichWindow, where, &resizeLimits, &NewContentRect);
|
|
1751 newWidth = NewContentRect.right - NewContentRect.left;
|
|
1752 newHeight = NewContentRect.bottom - NewContentRect.top;
|
|
1753 gui_resize_shell(newWidth, newHeight);
|
|
1754 gui_mch_set_bg_color(gui.back_pixel);
|
812
|
1755 gui_set_shellsize(TRUE, FALSE, RESIZE_BOTH);
|
7
|
1756 }
|
|
1757
|
|
1758 /*
|
|
1759 * Handle the click in the zoom box
|
|
1760 */
|
|
1761 static void
|
593
|
1762 gui_mac_doInZoomClick(EventRecord *theEvent, WindowPtr whichWindow)
|
7
|
1763 {
|
|
1764 Rect r;
|
|
1765 Point p;
|
|
1766 short thePart;
|
|
1767
|
|
1768 /* ideal width is current */
|
|
1769 p.h = Columns * gui.char_width + 2 * gui.border_offset;
|
|
1770 if (gui.which_scrollbars[SBAR_LEFT])
|
|
1771 p.h += gui.scrollbar_width;
|
|
1772 if (gui.which_scrollbars[SBAR_RIGHT])
|
|
1773 p.h += gui.scrollbar_width;
|
|
1774 /* ideal height is as heigh as we can get */
|
|
1775 p.v = 15 * 1024;
|
|
1776
|
|
1777 thePart = IsWindowInStandardState(whichWindow, &p, &r)
|
|
1778 ? inZoomIn : inZoomOut;
|
|
1779
|
|
1780 if (!TrackBox(whichWindow, theEvent->where, thePart))
|
|
1781 return;
|
|
1782
|
|
1783 /* use returned width */
|
|
1784 p.h = r.right - r.left;
|
|
1785 /* adjust returned height */
|
|
1786 p.v = r.bottom - r.top - 2 * gui.border_offset;
|
|
1787 if (gui.which_scrollbars[SBAR_BOTTOM])
|
|
1788 p.v -= gui.scrollbar_height;
|
|
1789 p.v -= p.v % gui.char_height;
|
|
1790 p.v += 2 * gui.border_width;
|
|
1791 if (gui.which_scrollbars[SBAR_BOTTOM]);
|
|
1792 p.v += gui.scrollbar_height;
|
|
1793
|
|
1794 ZoomWindowIdeal(whichWindow, thePart, &p);
|
|
1795
|
|
1796 GetWindowBounds(whichWindow, kWindowContentRgn, &r);
|
|
1797 gui_resize_shell(r.right - r.left, r.bottom - r.top);
|
|
1798 gui_mch_set_bg_color(gui.back_pixel);
|
812
|
1799 gui_set_shellsize(TRUE, FALSE, RESIZE_BOTH);
|
7
|
1800 }
|
|
1801
|
|
1802 /*
|
|
1803 * ------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
1804 * MacOS Event Handling procedure
|
|
1805 * ------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
1806 */
|
|
1807
|
|
1808 /*
|
|
1809 * Handle the Update Event
|
|
1810 */
|
|
1811
|
|
1812 void
|
593
|
1813 gui_mac_doUpdateEvent(EventRecord *event)
|
7
|
1814 {
|
|
1815 WindowPtr whichWindow;
|
|
1816 GrafPtr savePort;
|
|
1817 RgnHandle updateRgn;
|
|
1818 Rect updateRect;
|
|
1819 Rect *updateRectPtr;
|
|
1820 Rect rc;
|
|
1821 Rect growRect;
|
|
1822 RgnHandle saveRgn;
|
|
1823
|
|
1824
|
|
1825 updateRgn = NewRgn();
|
|
1826 if (updateRgn == NULL)
|
|
1827 return;
|
|
1828
|
|
1829 /* This could be done by the caller as we
|
|
1830 * don't require anything else out of the event
|
|
1831 */
|
|
1832 whichWindow = (WindowPtr) event->message;
|
|
1833
|
|
1834 /* Save Current Port */
|
9
|
1835 GetPort(&savePort);
|
7
|
1836
|
|
1837 /* Select the Window's Port */
|
9
|
1838 SetPortWindowPort(whichWindow);
|
7
|
1839
|
|
1840 /* Let's update the window */
|
9
|
1841 BeginUpdate(whichWindow);
|
7
|
1842 /* Redraw the biggest rectangle covering the area
|
|
1843 * to be updated.
|
|
1844 */
|
|
1845 GetPortVisibleRegion(GetWindowPort(whichWindow), updateRgn);
|
|
1846 # if 0
|
|
1847 /* Would be more appropriate to use the follwing but doesn't
|
|
1848 * seem to work under MacOS X (Dany)
|
|
1849 */
|
|
1850 GetWindowRegion(whichWindow, kWindowUpdateRgn, updateRgn);
|
|
1851 # endif
|
593
|
1852
|
7
|
1853 /* Use the HLock useless in Carbon? Is it harmful?*/
|
9
|
1854 HLock((Handle) updateRgn);
|
593
|
1855
|
9
|
1856 updateRectPtr = GetRegionBounds(updateRgn, &updateRect);
|
7
|
1857 # if 0
|
|
1858 /* Code from original Carbon Port (using GetWindowRegion.
|
|
1859 * I believe the UpdateRgn is already in local (Dany)
|
|
1860 */
|
|
1861 GlobalToLocal(&topLeft(updateRect)); /* preCarbon? */
|
|
1862 GlobalToLocal(&botRight(updateRect));
|
|
1863 # endif
|
|
1864 /* Update the content (i.e. the text) */
|
|
1865 gui_redraw(updateRectPtr->left, updateRectPtr->top,
|
|
1866 updateRectPtr->right - updateRectPtr->left,
|
|
1867 updateRectPtr->bottom - updateRectPtr->top);
|
|
1868 /* Clear the border areas if needed */
|
|
1869 gui_mch_set_bg_color(gui.back_pixel);
|
|
1870 if (updateRectPtr->left < FILL_X(0))
|
|
1871 {
|
9
|
1872 SetRect(&rc, 0, 0, FILL_X(0), FILL_Y(Rows));
|
|
1873 EraseRect(&rc);
|
7
|
1874 }
|
|
1875 if (updateRectPtr->top < FILL_Y(0))
|
|
1876 {
|
9
|
1877 SetRect(&rc, 0, 0, FILL_X(Columns), FILL_Y(0));
|
|
1878 EraseRect(&rc);
|
7
|
1879 }
|
|
1880 if (updateRectPtr->right > FILL_X(Columns))
|
|
1881 {
|
9
|
1882 SetRect(&rc, FILL_X(Columns), 0,
|
7
|
1883 FILL_X(Columns) + gui.border_offset, FILL_Y(Rows));
|
9
|
1884 EraseRect(&rc);
|
7
|
1885 }
|
|
1886 if (updateRectPtr->bottom > FILL_Y(Rows))
|
|
1887 {
|
9
|
1888 SetRect(&rc, 0, FILL_Y(Rows), FILL_X(Columns) + gui.border_offset,
|
7
|
1889 FILL_Y(Rows) + gui.border_offset);
|
9
|
1890 EraseRect(&rc);
|
7
|
1891 }
|
9
|
1892 HUnlock((Handle) updateRgn);
|
|
1893 DisposeRgn(updateRgn);
|
7
|
1894
|
|
1895 /* Update scrollbars */
|
9
|
1896 DrawControls(whichWindow);
|
7
|
1897
|
|
1898 /* Update the GrowBox */
|
|
1899 /* Taken from FAQ 33-27 */
|
|
1900 saveRgn = NewRgn();
|
|
1901 GetWindowBounds(whichWindow, kWindowGrowRgn, &growRect);
|
9
|
1902 GetClip(saveRgn);
|
|
1903 ClipRect(&growRect);
|
|
1904 DrawGrowIcon(whichWindow);
|
|
1905 SetClip(saveRgn);
|
|
1906 DisposeRgn(saveRgn);
|
|
1907 EndUpdate(whichWindow);
|
7
|
1908
|
|
1909 /* Restore original Port */
|
9
|
1910 SetPort(savePort);
|
7
|
1911 }
|
|
1912
|
|
1913 /*
|
|
1914 * Handle the activate/deactivate event
|
|
1915 * (apply to a window)
|
|
1916 */
|
|
1917 void
|
593
|
1918 gui_mac_doActivateEvent(EventRecord *event)
|
7
|
1919 {
|
|
1920 WindowPtr whichWindow;
|
|
1921
|
|
1922 whichWindow = (WindowPtr) event->message;
|
|
1923 if ((event->modifiers) & activeFlag)
|
|
1924 /* Activate */
|
|
1925 gui_focus_change(TRUE);
|
|
1926 else
|
|
1927 {
|
|
1928 /* Deactivate */
|
|
1929 gui_focus_change(FALSE);
|
|
1930 /* DON'T KNOW what the code below was doing
|
|
1931 found in the deactivate clause, but the
|
|
1932 clause writting TRUE into in_focus (BUG)
|
|
1933 */
|
|
1934
|
|
1935 #if 0 /* Removed by Dany as per above June 2001 */
|
|
1936 a_bool = false;
|
9
|
1937 SetPreserveGlyph(a_bool);
|
|
1938 SetOutlinePreferred(a_bool);
|
7
|
1939 #endif
|
|
1940 }
|
|
1941 }
|
|
1942
|
|
1943
|
|
1944 /*
|
|
1945 * Handle the suspend/resume event
|
|
1946 * (apply to the application)
|
|
1947 */
|
|
1948 void
|
593
|
1949 gui_mac_doSuspendEvent(EventRecord *event)
|
7
|
1950 {
|
|
1951 /* The frontmost application just changed */
|
|
1952
|
|
1953 /* NOTE: the suspend may happen before the deactivate
|
|
1954 * seen on MacOS X
|
|
1955 */
|
|
1956
|
|
1957 /* May not need to change focus as the window will
|
|
1958 * get an activate/desactivate event
|
|
1959 */
|
|
1960 if (event->message & 1)
|
|
1961 /* Resume */
|
|
1962 gui_focus_change(TRUE);
|
|
1963 else
|
|
1964 /* Suspend */
|
|
1965 gui_focus_change(FALSE);
|
|
1966 }
|
|
1967
|
|
1968 /*
|
|
1969 * Handle the key
|
|
1970 */
|
168
|
1971 #ifdef USE_CARBONKEYHANDLER
|
857
|
1972
|
|
1973 static int dialog_busy = FALSE; /* TRUE when gui_mch_dialog() wants the keys */
|
|
1974
|
168
|
1975 # define INLINE_KEY_BUFFER_SIZE 80
|
|
1976 static pascal OSStatus
|
593
|
1977 gui_mac_doKeyEventCarbon(
|
|
1978 EventHandlerCallRef nextHandler,
|
|
1979 EventRef theEvent,
|
168
|
1980 void *data)
|
|
1981 {
|
|
1982 /* Multibyte-friendly key event handler */
|
1012
|
1983 OSStatus err = -1;
|
168
|
1984 UInt32 actualSize;
|
|
1985 UniChar *text;
|
|
1986 char_u result[INLINE_KEY_BUFFER_SIZE];
|
|
1987 short len = 0;
|
|
1988 UInt32 key_sym;
|
|
1989 char charcode;
|
|
1990 int key_char;
|
1012
|
1991 UInt32 modifiers, vimModifiers;
|
168
|
1992 size_t encLen;
|
|
1993 char_u *to = NULL;
|
|
1994 Boolean isSpecial = FALSE;
|
|
1995 int i;
|
1012
|
1996 EventRef keyEvent;
|
168
|
1997
|
|
1998 /* Mask the mouse (as per user setting) */
|
|
1999 if (p_mh)
|
|
2000 ObscureCursor();
|
|
2001
|
1012
|
2002 /* Don't use the keys when the dialog wants them. */
|
|
2003 if (dialog_busy)
|
|
2004 return eventNotHandledErr;
|
|
2005
|
|
2006 if (noErr != GetEventParameter(theEvent, kEventParamTextInputSendText,
|
|
2007 typeUnicodeText, NULL, 0, &actualSize, NULL))
|
|
2008 return eventNotHandledErr;
|
|
2009
|
|
2010 text = (UniChar *)alloc(actualSize);
|
|
2011 if (!text)
|
|
2012 return eventNotHandledErr;
|
|
2013
|
|
2014 err = GetEventParameter(theEvent, kEventParamTextInputSendText,
|
|
2015 typeUnicodeText, NULL, actualSize, NULL, text);
|
|
2016 require_noerr(err, done);
|
|
2017
|
|
2018 err = GetEventParameter(theEvent, kEventParamTextInputSendKeyboardEvent,
|
|
2019 typeEventRef, NULL, sizeof(EventRef), NULL, &keyEvent);
|
|
2020 require_noerr(err, done);
|
|
2021
|
|
2022 err = GetEventParameter(keyEvent, kEventParamKeyModifiers,
|
|
2023 typeUInt32, NULL, sizeof(UInt32), NULL, &modifiers);
|
|
2024 require_noerr(err, done);
|
|
2025
|
|
2026 err = GetEventParameter(keyEvent, kEventParamKeyCode,
|
|
2027 typeUInt32, NULL, sizeof(UInt32), NULL, &key_sym);
|
|
2028 require_noerr(err, done);
|
|
2029
|
|
2030 err = GetEventParameter(keyEvent, kEventParamKeyMacCharCodes,
|
|
2031 typeChar, NULL, sizeof(char), NULL, &charcode);
|
|
2032 require_noerr(err, done);
|
|
2033
|
168
|
2034 #ifndef USE_CMD_KEY
|
1012
|
2035 if (modifiers & cmdKey)
|
|
2036 goto done; /* Let system handle Cmd+... */
|
168
|
2037 #endif
|
1012
|
2038
|
|
2039 key_char = charcode;
|
|
2040 vimModifiers = EventModifiers2VimModifiers(modifiers);
|
|
2041
|
|
2042 /* Find the special key (eg., for cursor keys) */
|
|
2043 if (actualSize <= sizeof(UniChar) &&
|
|
2044 ((text[0] < 0x20) || (text[0] == 0x7f)))
|
|
2045 {
|
|
2046 for (i = 0; special_keys[i].key_sym != (KeySym)0; ++i)
|
|
2047 if (special_keys[i].key_sym == key_sym)
|
|
2048 {
|
|
2049 key_char = TO_SPECIAL(special_keys[i].vim_code0,
|
|
2050 special_keys[i].vim_code1);
|
|
2051 key_char = simplify_key(key_char,
|
|
2052 (int *)&vimModifiers);
|
|
2053 isSpecial = TRUE;
|
|
2054 break;
|
|
2055 }
|
168
|
2056 }
|
1012
|
2057
|
|
2058 /* Intercept CMD-. and CTRL-c */
|
|
2059 if (((modifiers & controlKey) && key_char == 'c') ||
|
|
2060 ((modifiers & cmdKey) && key_char == '.'))
|
|
2061 got_int = TRUE;
|
|
2062
|
|
2063 if (!isSpecial)
|
|
2064 {
|
|
2065 /* remove SHIFT for keys that are already shifted, e.g.,
|
|
2066 * '(' and '*' */
|
|
2067 if (key_char < 0x100 && !isalpha(key_char) && isprint(key_char))
|
|
2068 vimModifiers &= ~MOD_MASK_SHIFT;
|
|
2069
|
|
2070 /* remove CTRL from keys that already have it */
|
|
2071 if (key_char < 0x20)
|
|
2072 vimModifiers &= ~MOD_MASK_CTRL;
|
|
2073
|
|
2074 /* don't process unicode characters here */
|
|
2075 if (!IS_SPECIAL(key_char))
|
|
2076 {
|
|
2077 /* Following code to simplify and consolidate vimModifiers
|
|
2078 * taken liberally from gui_w48.c */
|
|
2079 key_char = simplify_key(key_char, (int *)&vimModifiers);
|
|
2080
|
|
2081 /* Interpret META, include SHIFT, etc. */
|
|
2082 key_char = extract_modifiers(key_char, (int *)&vimModifiers);
|
|
2083 if (key_char == CSI)
|
|
2084 key_char = K_CSI;
|
|
2085
|
|
2086 if (IS_SPECIAL(key_char))
|
|
2087 isSpecial = TRUE;
|
|
2088 }
|
|
2089 }
|
|
2090
|
|
2091 if (vimModifiers)
|
|
2092 {
|
|
2093 result[len++] = CSI;
|
|
2094 result[len++] = KS_MODIFIER;
|
|
2095 result[len++] = vimModifiers;
|
|
2096 }
|
|
2097
|
|
2098 if (isSpecial && IS_SPECIAL(key_char))
|
|
2099 {
|
|
2100 result[len++] = CSI;
|
|
2101 result[len++] = K_SECOND(key_char);
|
|
2102 result[len++] = K_THIRD(key_char);
|
|
2103 }
|
|
2104 else
|
|
2105 {
|
|
2106 encLen = actualSize;
|
|
2107 to = mac_utf16_to_enc(text, actualSize, &encLen);
|
|
2108 if (to)
|
|
2109 {
|
|
2110 /* This is basically add_to_input_buf_csi() */
|
|
2111 for (i = 0; i < encLen && len < (INLINE_KEY_BUFFER_SIZE-1); ++i)
|
|
2112 {
|
|
2113 result[len++] = to[i];
|
|
2114 if (to[i] == CSI)
|
|
2115 {
|
|
2116 result[len++] = KS_EXTRA;
|
|
2117 result[len++] = (int)KE_CSI;
|
|
2118 }
|
|
2119 }
|
|
2120 vim_free(to);
|
|
2121 }
|
|
2122 }
|
|
2123
|
|
2124 add_to_input_buf(result, len);
|
|
2125 err = noErr;
|
|
2126
|
|
2127 done:
|
|
2128 vim_free(text);
|
|
2129 if (err == noErr)
|
|
2130 {
|
|
2131 /* Fake event to wake up WNE (required to get
|
|
2132 * key repeat working */
|
|
2133 PostEvent(keyUp, 0);
|
|
2134 return noErr;
|
|
2135 }
|
|
2136
|
|
2137 return eventNotHandledErr;
|
168
|
2138 }
|
|
2139 #else
|
7
|
2140 void
|
|
2141 gui_mac_doKeyEvent(EventRecord *theEvent)
|
|
2142 {
|
|
2143 /* TODO: add support for COMMAND KEY */
|
|
2144 long menu;
|
|
2145 unsigned char string[20];
|
|
2146 short num, i;
|
|
2147 short len = 0;
|
|
2148 KeySym key_sym;
|
|
2149 int key_char;
|
|
2150 int modifiers;
|
26
|
2151 int simplify = FALSE;
|
7
|
2152
|
|
2153 /* Mask the mouse (as per user setting) */
|
|
2154 if (p_mh)
|
|
2155 ObscureCursor();
|
|
2156
|
|
2157 /* Get the key code and it's ASCII representation */
|
|
2158 key_sym = ((theEvent->message & keyCodeMask) >> 8);
|
|
2159 key_char = theEvent->message & charCodeMask;
|
|
2160 num = 1;
|
|
2161
|
|
2162 /* Intercept CTRL-C */
|
|
2163 if (theEvent->modifiers & controlKey)
|
9
|
2164 {
|
7
|
2165 if (key_char == Ctrl_C && ctrl_c_interrupts)
|
|
2166 got_int = TRUE;
|
9
|
2167 else if ((theEvent->modifiers & ~(controlKey|shiftKey)) == 0
|
|
2168 && (key_char == '2' || key_char == '6'))
|
|
2169 {
|
|
2170 /* CTRL-^ and CTRL-@ don't work in the normal way. */
|
|
2171 if (key_char == '2')
|
|
2172 key_char = Ctrl_AT;
|
|
2173 else
|
|
2174 key_char = Ctrl_HAT;
|
|
2175 theEvent->modifiers = 0;
|
|
2176 }
|
|
2177 }
|
7
|
2178
|
|
2179 /* Intercept CMD-. */
|
|
2180 if (theEvent->modifiers & cmdKey)
|
|
2181 if (key_char == '.')
|
|
2182 got_int = TRUE;
|
|
2183
|
|
2184 /* Handle command key as per menu */
|
|
2185 /* TODO: should override be allowed? Require YAO or could use 'winaltkey' */
|
|
2186 if (theEvent->modifiers & cmdKey)
|
|
2187 /* Only accept CMD alone or with CAPLOCKS and the mouse button.
|
|
2188 * Why the mouse button? */
|
|
2189 if ((theEvent->modifiers & (~(cmdKey | btnState | alphaLock))) == 0)
|
|
2190 {
|
|
2191 menu = MenuKey(key_char);
|
|
2192 if (HiWord(menu))
|
|
2193 {
|
|
2194 gui_mac_handle_menu(menu);
|
|
2195 return;
|
|
2196 }
|
|
2197 }
|
|
2198
|
|
2199 /* Convert the modifiers */
|
|
2200 modifiers = EventModifiers2VimModifiers(theEvent->modifiers);
|
|
2201
|
|
2202
|
|
2203 /* Handle special keys. */
|
|
2204 #if 0
|
26
|
2205 /* Why has this been removed? */
|
7
|
2206 if (!(theEvent->modifiers & (cmdKey | controlKey | rightControlKey)))
|
|
2207 #endif
|
|
2208 {
|
|
2209 /* Find the special key (for non-printable keyt_char) */
|
|
2210 if ((key_char < 0x20) || (key_char == 0x7f))
|
|
2211 for (i = 0; special_keys[i].key_sym != (KeySym)0; i++)
|
|
2212 if (special_keys[i].key_sym == key_sym)
|
|
2213 {
|
|
2214 # if 0
|
|
2215 /* We currently don't have not so special key */
|
|
2216 if (special_keys[i].vim_code1 == NUL)
|
|
2217 key_char = special_keys[i].vim_code0;
|
|
2218 else
|
|
2219 # endif
|
9
|
2220 key_char = TO_SPECIAL(special_keys[i].vim_code0,
|
|
2221 special_keys[i].vim_code1);
|
26
|
2222 simplify = TRUE;
|
7
|
2223 break;
|
|
2224 }
|
|
2225 }
|
|
2226
|
26
|
2227 /* For some keys the modifier is included in the char itself. */
|
|
2228 if (simplify || key_char == TAB || key_char == ' ')
|
|
2229 key_char = simplify_key(key_char, &modifiers);
|
7
|
2230
|
|
2231 /* Add the modifier to the input bu if needed */
|
|
2232 /* Do not want SHIFT-A or CTRL-A with modifier */
|
|
2233 if (!IS_SPECIAL(key_char)
|
|
2234 && key_sym != vk_Space
|
|
2235 && key_sym != vk_Tab
|
|
2236 && key_sym != vk_Return
|
|
2237 && key_sym != vk_Enter
|
|
2238 && key_sym != vk_Esc)
|
|
2239 {
|
|
2240 #if 1
|
|
2241 /* Clear modifiers when only one modifier is set */
|
9
|
2242 if ((modifiers == MOD_MASK_SHIFT)
|
|
2243 || (modifiers == MOD_MASK_CTRL)
|
|
2244 || (modifiers == MOD_MASK_ALT))
|
7
|
2245 modifiers = 0;
|
|
2246 #else
|
9
|
2247 if (modifiers & MOD_MASK_CTRL)
|
7
|
2248 modifiers = modifiers & ~MOD_MASK_CTRL;
|
9
|
2249 if (modifiers & MOD_MASK_ALT)
|
7
|
2250 modifiers = modifiers & ~MOD_MASK_ALT;
|
9
|
2251 if (modifiers & MOD_MASK_SHIFT)
|
7
|
2252 modifiers = modifiers & ~MOD_MASK_SHIFT;
|
|
2253 #endif
|
|
2254 }
|
9
|
2255 if (modifiers)
|
7
|
2256 {
|
9
|
2257 string[len++] = CSI;
|
|
2258 string[len++] = KS_MODIFIER;
|
|
2259 string[len++] = modifiers;
|
7
|
2260 }
|
|
2261
|
9
|
2262 if (IS_SPECIAL(key_char))
|
7
|
2263 {
|
9
|
2264 string[len++] = CSI;
|
|
2265 string[len++] = K_SECOND(key_char);
|
|
2266 string[len++] = K_THIRD(key_char);
|
7
|
2267 }
|
|
2268 else
|
|
2269 {
|
|
2270 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
|
9
|
2271 /* Convert characters when needed (e.g., from MacRoman to latin1).
|
|
2272 * This doesn't work for the NUL byte. */
|
|
2273 if (input_conv.vc_type != CONV_NONE && key_char > 0)
|
7
|
2274 {
|
|
2275 char_u from[2], *to;
|
|
2276 int l;
|
|
2277
|
|
2278 from[0] = key_char;
|
|
2279 from[1] = NUL;
|
|
2280 l = 1;
|
|
2281 to = string_convert(&input_conv, from, &l);
|
|
2282 if (to != NULL)
|
|
2283 {
|
|
2284 for (i = 0; i < l && len < 19; i++)
|
|
2285 {
|
|
2286 if (to[i] == CSI)
|
|
2287 {
|
|
2288 string[len++] = KS_EXTRA;
|
|
2289 string[len++] = KE_CSI;
|
|
2290 }
|
|
2291 else
|
|
2292 string[len++] = to[i];
|
|
2293 }
|
|
2294 vim_free(to);
|
|
2295 }
|
|
2296 else
|
|
2297 string[len++] = key_char;
|
|
2298 }
|
|
2299 else
|
|
2300 #endif
|
|
2301 string[len++] = key_char;
|
|
2302 }
|
|
2303
|
|
2304 if (len == 1 && string[0] == CSI)
|
|
2305 {
|
|
2306 /* Turn CSI into K_CSI. */
|
|
2307 string[ len++ ] = KS_EXTRA;
|
|
2308 string[ len++ ] = KE_CSI;
|
|
2309 }
|
|
2310
|
|
2311 add_to_input_buf(string, len);
|
|
2312 }
|
168
|
2313 #endif
|
7
|
2314
|
|
2315 /*
|
|
2316 * Handle MouseClick
|
|
2317 */
|
|
2318 void
|
593
|
2319 gui_mac_doMouseDownEvent(EventRecord *theEvent)
|
7
|
2320 {
|
|
2321 short thePart;
|
|
2322 WindowPtr whichWindow;
|
|
2323
|
9
|
2324 thePart = FindWindow(theEvent->where, &whichWindow);
|
7
|
2325
|
1106
|
2326 #ifdef FEAT_GUI_TABLINE
|
|
2327 /* prevent that the vim window size changes if it's activated by a
|
|
2328 click into the tab pane */
|
|
2329 if (whichWindow == drawer)
|
|
2330 return;
|
|
2331 #endif
|
|
2332
|
7
|
2333 switch (thePart)
|
|
2334 {
|
|
2335 case (inDesk):
|
|
2336 /* TODO: what to do? */
|
|
2337 break;
|
|
2338
|
|
2339 case (inMenuBar):
|
9
|
2340 gui_mac_handle_menu(MenuSelect(theEvent->where));
|
7
|
2341 break;
|
|
2342
|
|
2343 case (inContent):
|
9
|
2344 gui_mac_doInContentClick(theEvent, whichWindow);
|
7
|
2345 break;
|
|
2346
|
|
2347 case (inDrag):
|
9
|
2348 gui_mac_doInDragClick(theEvent->where, whichWindow);
|
7
|
2349 break;
|
|
2350
|
|
2351 case (inGrow):
|
9
|
2352 gui_mac_doInGrowClick(theEvent->where, whichWindow);
|
7
|
2353 break;
|
|
2354
|
|
2355 case (inGoAway):
|
|
2356 if (TrackGoAway(whichWindow, theEvent->where))
|
|
2357 gui_shell_closed();
|
|
2358 break;
|
|
2359
|
|
2360 case (inZoomIn):
|
|
2361 case (inZoomOut):
|
|
2362 gui_mac_doInZoomClick(theEvent, whichWindow);
|
|
2363 break;
|
|
2364 }
|
|
2365 }
|
|
2366
|
|
2367 /*
|
|
2368 * Handle MouseMoved
|
|
2369 * [this event is a moving in and out of a region]
|
|
2370 */
|
|
2371 void
|
593
|
2372 gui_mac_doMouseMovedEvent(EventRecord *event)
|
7
|
2373 {
|
|
2374 Point thePoint;
|
|
2375 int_u vimModifiers;
|
|
2376
|
|
2377 thePoint = event->where;
|
9
|
2378 GlobalToLocal(&thePoint);
|
7
|
2379 vimModifiers = EventModifiers2VimMouseModifiers(event->modifiers);
|
|
2380
|
|
2381 if (!Button())
|
9
|
2382 gui_mouse_moved(thePoint.h, thePoint.v);
|
7
|
2383 else
|
|
2384 if (!clickIsPopup)
|
|
2385 gui_send_mouse_event(MOUSE_DRAG, thePoint.h,
|
|
2386 thePoint.v, FALSE, vimModifiers);
|
|
2387
|
|
2388 /* Reset the region from which we move in and out */
|
9
|
2389 SetRect(&dragRect, FILL_X(X_2_COL(thePoint.h)),
|
7
|
2390 FILL_Y(Y_2_ROW(thePoint.v)),
|
|
2391 FILL_X(X_2_COL(thePoint.h)+1),
|
|
2392 FILL_Y(Y_2_ROW(thePoint.v)+1));
|
|
2393
|
|
2394 if (dragRectEnbl)
|
|
2395 dragRectControl = kCreateRect;
|
|
2396
|
|
2397 }
|
|
2398
|
|
2399 /*
|
|
2400 * Handle the mouse release
|
|
2401 */
|
|
2402 void
|
593
|
2403 gui_mac_doMouseUpEvent(EventRecord *theEvent)
|
7
|
2404 {
|
|
2405 Point thePoint;
|
|
2406 int_u vimModifiers;
|
|
2407
|
|
2408 /* TODO: Properly convert the Contextual menu mouse-up */
|
|
2409 /* Potential source of the double menu */
|
|
2410 lastMouseTick = theEvent->when;
|
|
2411 dragRectEnbl = FALSE;
|
|
2412 dragRectControl = kCreateEmpty;
|
|
2413 thePoint = theEvent->where;
|
9
|
2414 GlobalToLocal(&thePoint);
|
7
|
2415
|
|
2416 vimModifiers = EventModifiers2VimMouseModifiers(theEvent->modifiers);
|
|
2417 if (clickIsPopup)
|
|
2418 {
|
|
2419 vimModifiers &= ~MOUSE_CTRL;
|
|
2420 clickIsPopup = FALSE;
|
|
2421 }
|
9
|
2422 gui_send_mouse_event(MOUSE_RELEASE, thePoint.h, thePoint.v, FALSE, vimModifiers);
|
7
|
2423 }
|
|
2424
|
|
2425 static pascal OSStatus
|
|
2426 gui_mac_mouse_wheel(EventHandlerCallRef nextHandler, EventRef theEvent,
|
|
2427 void *data)
|
|
2428 {
|
|
2429 EventRef bogusEvent;
|
|
2430 Point point;
|
|
2431 Rect bounds;
|
|
2432 UInt32 mod;
|
|
2433 SInt32 delta;
|
|
2434 int_u vim_mod;
|
939
|
2435 EventMouseWheelAxis axis;
|
|
2436
|
|
2437 if (noErr == GetEventParameter(theEvent, kEventParamMouseWheelAxis,
|
|
2438 typeMouseWheelAxis, NULL, sizeof(axis), NULL, &axis)
|
|
2439 && axis != kEventMouseWheelAxisY)
|
|
2440 goto bail; /* Vim only does up-down scrolling */
|
7
|
2441
|
|
2442 if (noErr != GetEventParameter(theEvent, kEventParamMouseWheelDelta,
|
|
2443 typeSInt32, NULL, sizeof(SInt32), NULL, &delta))
|
|
2444 goto bail;
|
|
2445 if (noErr != GetEventParameter(theEvent, kEventParamMouseLocation,
|
|
2446 typeQDPoint, NULL, sizeof(Point), NULL, &point))
|
|
2447 goto bail;
|
|
2448 if (noErr != GetEventParameter(theEvent, kEventParamKeyModifiers,
|
|
2449 typeUInt32, NULL, sizeof(UInt32), NULL, &mod))
|
|
2450 goto bail;
|
|
2451
|
|
2452 vim_mod = 0;
|
|
2453 if (mod & shiftKey)
|
|
2454 vim_mod |= MOUSE_SHIFT;
|
|
2455 if (mod & controlKey)
|
|
2456 vim_mod |= MOUSE_CTRL;
|
|
2457 if (mod & optionKey)
|
|
2458 vim_mod |= MOUSE_ALT;
|
|
2459
|
|
2460 /* post a bogus event to wake up WaitNextEvent */
|
|
2461 if (noErr != CreateEvent(NULL, kEventClassMouse, kEventMouseMoved, 0,
|
|
2462 kEventAttributeNone, &bogusEvent))
|
|
2463 goto bail;
|
|
2464 if (noErr != PostEventToQueue(GetMainEventQueue(), bogusEvent,
|
|
2465 kEventPriorityLow))
|
|
2466 goto bail;
|
|
2467
|
37
|
2468 ReleaseEvent(bogusEvent);
|
|
2469
|
7
|
2470 if (noErr == GetWindowBounds(gui.VimWindow, kWindowContentRgn, &bounds))
|
|
2471 {
|
|
2472 point.h -= bounds.left;
|
|
2473 point.v -= bounds.top;
|
|
2474 }
|
|
2475
|
|
2476 gui_send_mouse_event((delta > 0) ? MOUSE_4 : MOUSE_5,
|
|
2477 point.h, point.v, FALSE, vim_mod);
|
|
2478
|
|
2479 return noErr;
|
|
2480
|
1107
|
2481 bail:
|
7
|
2482 /*
|
|
2483 * when we fail give any additional callback handler a chance to perform
|
|
2484 * it's actions
|
|
2485 */
|
|
2486 return CallNextEventHandler(nextHandler, theEvent);
|
|
2487 }
|
|
2488
|
|
2489 #if 0
|
|
2490
|
|
2491 /*
|
|
2492 * This would be the normal way of invoking the contextual menu
|
|
2493 * but the Vim API doesn't seem to a support a request to get
|
|
2494 * the menu that we should display
|
|
2495 */
|
|
2496 void
|
|
2497 gui_mac_handle_contextual_menu(event)
|
|
2498 EventRecord *event;
|
|
2499 {
|
|
2500 /*
|
|
2501 * Clone PopUp to use menu
|
|
2502 * Create a object descriptor for the current selection
|
|
2503 * Call the procedure
|
|
2504 */
|
|
2505
|
|
2506 // Call to Handle Popup
|
|
2507 OSStatus status = ContextualMenuSelect(CntxMenu, event->where, false, kCMHelpItemNoHelp, "", NULL, &CntxType, &CntxMenuID, &CntxMenuItem);
|
|
2508
|
|
2509 if (status != noErr)
|
|
2510 return;
|
|
2511
|
|
2512 if (CntxType == kCMMenuItemSelected)
|
|
2513 {
|
|
2514 /* Handle the menu CntxMenuID, CntxMenuItem */
|
|
2515 /* The submenu can be handle directly by gui_mac_handle_menu */
|
|
2516 /* But what about the current menu, is the meny changed by ContextualMenuSelect */
|
9
|
2517 gui_mac_handle_menu((CntxMenuID << 16) + CntxMenuItem);
|
7
|
2518 }
|
|
2519 else if (CntxMenuID == kCMShowHelpSelected)
|
|
2520 {
|
|
2521 /* Should come up with the help */
|
|
2522 }
|
|
2523
|
|
2524 }
|
|
2525 #endif
|
|
2526
|
|
2527 /*
|
|
2528 * Handle menubar selection
|
|
2529 */
|
|
2530 void
|
593
|
2531 gui_mac_handle_menu(long menuChoice)
|
7
|
2532 {
|
|
2533 short menu = HiWord(menuChoice);
|
|
2534 short item = LoWord(menuChoice);
|
|
2535 vimmenu_T *theVimMenu = root_menu;
|
|
2536
|
|
2537 if (menu == 256) /* TODO: use constant or gui.xyz */
|
|
2538 {
|
|
2539 if (item == 1)
|
|
2540 gui_mch_beep(); /* TODO: Popup dialog or do :intro */
|
|
2541 }
|
|
2542 else if (item != 0)
|
|
2543 {
|
|
2544 theVimMenu = gui_mac_get_vim_menu(menu, item, root_menu);
|
|
2545
|
|
2546 if (theVimMenu)
|
|
2547 gui_menu_cb(theVimMenu);
|
|
2548 }
|
9
|
2549 HiliteMenu(0);
|
7
|
2550 }
|
|
2551
|
|
2552 /*
|
|
2553 * Dispatch the event to proper handler
|
|
2554 */
|
|
2555
|
|
2556 void
|
593
|
2557 gui_mac_handle_event(EventRecord *event)
|
7
|
2558 {
|
|
2559 OSErr error;
|
|
2560
|
|
2561 /* Handle contextual menu right now (if needed) */
|
|
2562 if (gui.MacOSHaveCntxMenu)
|
|
2563 if (IsShowContextualMenuClick(event))
|
|
2564 {
|
|
2565 # if 0
|
|
2566 gui_mac_handle_contextual_menu(event);
|
|
2567 # else
|
|
2568 gui_mac_doMouseDownEvent(event);
|
|
2569 # endif
|
|
2570 return;
|
|
2571 }
|
|
2572
|
|
2573 /* Handle normal event */
|
|
2574 switch (event->what)
|
|
2575 {
|
168
|
2576 #ifndef USE_CARBONKEYHANDLER
|
7
|
2577 case (keyDown):
|
|
2578 case (autoKey):
|
9
|
2579 gui_mac_doKeyEvent(event);
|
7
|
2580 break;
|
168
|
2581 #endif
|
7
|
2582 case (keyUp):
|
857
|
2583 /* We don't care about when the key is released */
|
7
|
2584 break;
|
|
2585
|
|
2586 case (mouseDown):
|
|
2587 gui_mac_doMouseDownEvent(event);
|
|
2588 break;
|
|
2589
|
|
2590 case (mouseUp):
|
|
2591 gui_mac_doMouseUpEvent(event);
|
|
2592 break;
|
|
2593
|
|
2594 case (updateEvt):
|
9
|
2595 gui_mac_doUpdateEvent(event);
|
7
|
2596 break;
|
|
2597
|
|
2598 case (diskEvt):
|
|
2599 /* We don't need special handling for disk insertion */
|
|
2600 break;
|
|
2601
|
|
2602 case (activateEvt):
|
9
|
2603 gui_mac_doActivateEvent(event);
|
7
|
2604 break;
|
|
2605
|
|
2606 case (osEvt):
|
|
2607 switch ((event->message >> 24) & 0xFF)
|
|
2608 {
|
|
2609 case (0xFA): /* mouseMovedMessage */
|
9
|
2610 gui_mac_doMouseMovedEvent(event);
|
7
|
2611 break;
|
|
2612 case (0x01): /* suspendResumeMessage */
|
9
|
2613 gui_mac_doSuspendEvent(event);
|
7
|
2614 break;
|
|
2615 }
|
|
2616 break;
|
|
2617
|
|
2618 #ifdef USE_AEVENT
|
|
2619 case (kHighLevelEvent):
|
|
2620 /* Someone's talking to us, through AppleEvents */
|
|
2621 error = AEProcessAppleEvent(event); /* TODO: Error Handling */
|
|
2622 break;
|
|
2623 #endif
|
|
2624 }
|
|
2625 }
|
|
2626
|
|
2627 /*
|
|
2628 * ------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
2629 * Unknown Stuff
|
|
2630 * ------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
2631 */
|
|
2632
|
|
2633
|
|
2634 GuiFont
|
593
|
2635 gui_mac_find_font(char_u *font_name)
|
7
|
2636 {
|
|
2637 char_u c;
|
|
2638 char_u *p;
|
|
2639 char_u pFontName[256];
|
|
2640 Str255 systemFontname;
|
|
2641 short font_id;
|
|
2642 short size=9;
|
|
2643 GuiFont font;
|
|
2644 #if 0
|
|
2645 char_u *fontNamePtr;
|
|
2646 #endif
|
|
2647
|
|
2648 for (p = font_name; ((*p != 0) && (*p != ':')); p++)
|
|
2649 ;
|
|
2650
|
|
2651 c = *p;
|
|
2652 *p = 0;
|
|
2653
|
|
2654 #if 1
|
|
2655 STRCPY(&pFontName[1], font_name);
|
|
2656 pFontName[0] = STRLEN(font_name);
|
|
2657 *p = c;
|
|
2658
|
168
|
2659 /* Get the font name, minus the style suffix (:h, etc) */
|
|
2660 char_u fontName[256];
|
|
2661 char_u *styleStart = vim_strchr(font_name, ':');
|
|
2662 size_t fontNameLen = styleStart ? styleStart - font_name : STRLEN(fontName);
|
|
2663 vim_strncpy(fontName, font_name, fontNameLen);
|
|
2664
|
|
2665 ATSUFontID fontRef;
|
|
2666 FMFontStyle fontStyle;
|
|
2667 font_id = 0;
|
|
2668
|
|
2669 if (ATSUFindFontFromName(&pFontName[1], pFontName[0], kFontFullName,
|
|
2670 kFontMacintoshPlatform, kFontNoScriptCode, kFontNoLanguageCode,
|
|
2671 &fontRef) == noErr)
|
|
2672 {
|
|
2673 if (FMGetFontFamilyInstanceFromFont(fontRef, &font_id, &fontStyle) != noErr)
|
|
2674 font_id = 0;
|
|
2675 }
|
13
|
2676
|
|
2677 if (font_id == 0)
|
|
2678 {
|
|
2679 /*
|
|
2680 * Try again, this time replacing underscores in the font name
|
|
2681 * with spaces (:set guifont allows the two to be used
|
|
2682 * interchangeably; the Font Manager doesn't).
|
|
2683 */
|
|
2684 int i, changed = FALSE;
|
|
2685
|
|
2686 for (i = pFontName[0]; i > 0; --i)
|
|
2687 {
|
|
2688 if (pFontName[i] == '_')
|
|
2689 {
|
|
2690 pFontName[i] = ' ';
|
|
2691 changed = TRUE;
|
|
2692 }
|
|
2693 }
|
|
2694 if (changed)
|
168
|
2695 if (ATSUFindFontFromName(&pFontName[1], pFontName[0],
|
|
2696 kFontFullName, kFontNoPlatformCode, kFontNoScriptCode,
|
|
2697 kFontNoLanguageCode, &fontRef) == noErr)
|
|
2698 {
|
|
2699 if (FMGetFontFamilyInstanceFromFont(fontRef, &font_id, &fontStyle) != noErr)
|
|
2700 font_id = 0;
|
|
2701 }
|
13
|
2702 }
|
|
2703
|
7
|
2704 #else
|
|
2705 /* name = C2Pascal_save(menu->dname); */
|
|
2706 fontNamePtr = C2Pascal_save_and_remove_backslash(font_name);
|
|
2707
|
9
|
2708 GetFNum(fontNamePtr, &font_id);
|
7
|
2709 #endif
|
|
2710
|
|
2711
|
|
2712 if (font_id == 0)
|
|
2713 {
|
|
2714 /* Oups, the system font was it the one the user want */
|
|
2715
|
168
|
2716 if (FMGetFontFamilyName(systemFont, systemFontname) != noErr)
|
|
2717 return NOFONT;
|
7
|
2718 if (!EqualString(pFontName, systemFontname, false, false))
|
|
2719 return NOFONT;
|
|
2720 }
|
|
2721 if (*p == ':')
|
|
2722 {
|
|
2723 p++;
|
|
2724 /* Set the values found after ':' */
|
|
2725 while (*p)
|
|
2726 {
|
|
2727 switch (*p++)
|
|
2728 {
|
|
2729 case 'h':
|
|
2730 size = points_to_pixels(p, &p, TRUE);
|
|
2731 break;
|
|
2732 /*
|
|
2733 * TODO: Maybe accept width and styles
|
|
2734 */
|
|
2735 }
|
|
2736 while (*p == ':')
|
|
2737 p++;
|
|
2738 }
|
|
2739 }
|
|
2740
|
|
2741 if (size < 1)
|
|
2742 size = 1; /* Avoid having a size of 0 with system font */
|
|
2743
|
|
2744 font = (size << 16) + ((long) font_id & 0xFFFF);
|
|
2745
|
|
2746 return font;
|
|
2747 }
|
|
2748
|
|
2749 /*
|
|
2750 * ------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
2751 * GUI_MCH functionnality
|
|
2752 * ------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
2753 */
|
|
2754
|
|
2755 /*
|
|
2756 * Parse the GUI related command-line arguments. Any arguments used are
|
|
2757 * deleted from argv, and *argc is decremented accordingly. This is called
|
|
2758 * when vim is started, whether or not the GUI has been started.
|
|
2759 */
|
|
2760 void
|
593
|
2761 gui_mch_prepare(int *argc, char **argv)
|
7
|
2762 {
|
|
2763 /* TODO: Move most of this stuff toward gui_mch_init */
|
|
2764 #ifdef USE_EXE_NAME
|
|
2765 FSSpec applDir;
|
|
2766 # ifndef USE_FIND_BUNDLE_PATH
|
|
2767 short applVRefNum;
|
|
2768 long applDirID;
|
|
2769 Str255 volName;
|
|
2770 # else
|
|
2771 ProcessSerialNumber psn;
|
|
2772 FSRef applFSRef;
|
|
2773 # endif
|
|
2774 #endif
|
|
2775
|
|
2776 #if 0
|
|
2777 InitCursor();
|
|
2778
|
|
2779 RegisterAppearanceClient();
|
|
2780
|
|
2781 #ifdef USE_AEVENT
|
|
2782 (void) InstallAEHandlers();
|
|
2783 #endif
|
|
2784
|
|
2785 if (Gestalt(gestaltContextualMenuAttr, &gestalt_rc) == noErr)
|
|
2786 gui.MacOSHaveCntxMenu = BitTst(&gestalt_rc, 31-gestaltContextualMenuTrapAvailable);
|
|
2787 else
|
|
2788 gui.MacOSHaveCntxMenu = false;
|
|
2789
|
|
2790 if (gui.MacOSHaveCntxMenu)
|
|
2791 gui.MacOSHaveCntxMenu = (InitContextualMenus()==noErr);
|
9
|
2792
|
|
2793 pomme = NewMenu(256, "\p\024"); /* 0x14= = Apple Menu */
|
|
2794
|
|
2795 AppendMenu(pomme, "\pAbout VIM");
|
|
2796
|
|
2797 InsertMenu(pomme, 0);
|
7
|
2798
|
|
2799 DrawMenuBar();
|
|
2800
|
|
2801
|
|
2802 #ifndef USE_OFFSETED_WINDOW
|
9
|
2803 SetRect(&windRect, 10, 48, 10+80*7 + 16, 48+24*11);
|
7
|
2804 #else
|
9
|
2805 SetRect(&windRect, 300, 40, 300+80*7 + 16, 40+24*11);
|
7
|
2806 #endif
|
|
2807
|
|
2808
|
|
2809 CreateNewWindow(kDocumentWindowClass,
|
|
2810 kWindowResizableAttribute | kWindowCollapseBoxAttribute,
|
9
|
2811 &windRect, &gui.VimWindow);
|
|
2812 SetPortWindowPort(gui.VimWindow);
|
7
|
2813
|
|
2814 gui.char_width = 7;
|
|
2815 gui.char_height = 11;
|
|
2816 gui.char_ascent = 6;
|
|
2817 gui.num_rows = 24;
|
|
2818 gui.num_cols = 80;
|
|
2819 gui.in_focus = TRUE; /* For the moment -> syn. of front application */
|
|
2820
|
9
|
2821 gScrollAction = NewControlActionUPP(gui_mac_scroll_action);
|
|
2822 gScrollDrag = NewControlActionUPP(gui_mac_drag_thumb);
|
7
|
2823
|
|
2824 dragRectEnbl = FALSE;
|
|
2825 dragRgn = NULL;
|
|
2826 dragRectControl = kCreateEmpty;
|
|
2827 cursorRgn = NewRgn();
|
|
2828 #endif
|
|
2829 #ifdef USE_EXE_NAME
|
|
2830 # ifndef USE_FIND_BUNDLE_PATH
|
9
|
2831 HGetVol(volName, &applVRefNum, &applDirID);
|
7
|
2832 /* TN2015: mention a possible bad VRefNum */
|
9
|
2833 FSMakeFSSpec(applVRefNum, applDirID, "\p", &applDir);
|
7
|
2834 # else
|
|
2835 /* OSErr GetApplicationBundleFSSpec(FSSpecPtr theFSSpecPtr)
|
|
2836 * of TN2015
|
|
2837 * This technic remove the ../Contents/MacOS/etc part
|
|
2838 */
|
9
|
2839 (void)GetCurrentProcess(&psn);
|
7
|
2840 /* if (err != noErr) return err; */
|
|
2841
|
9
|
2842 (void)GetProcessBundleLocation(&psn, &applFSRef);
|
7
|
2843 /* if (err != noErr) return err; */
|
|
2844
|
9
|
2845 (void)FSGetCatalogInfo(&applFSRef, kFSCatInfoNone, NULL, NULL, &applDir, NULL);
|
7
|
2846
|
|
2847 /* This technic return NIL when we disallow_gui */
|
|
2848 # endif
|
9
|
2849 exe_name = FullPathFromFSSpec_save(applDir);
|
7
|
2850 #endif
|
|
2851 }
|
|
2852
|
|
2853 #ifndef ALWAYS_USE_GUI
|
|
2854 /*
|
|
2855 * Check if the GUI can be started. Called before gvimrc is sourced.
|
|
2856 * Return OK or FAIL.
|
|
2857 */
|
|
2858 int
|
|
2859 gui_mch_init_check(void)
|
|
2860 {
|
|
2861 /* TODO: For MacOS X find a way to return FAIL, if the user logged in
|
|
2862 * using the >console
|
|
2863 */
|
|
2864 if (disallow_gui) /* see main.c for reason to disallow */
|
|
2865 return FAIL;
|
|
2866 return OK;
|
|
2867 }
|
|
2868 #endif
|
|
2869
|
|
2870 static OSErr
|
1107
|
2871 receiveHandler(WindowRef theWindow, void *handlerRefCon, DragRef theDrag)
|
7
|
2872 {
|
|
2873 int x, y;
|
|
2874 int_u modifiers;
|
|
2875 char_u **fnames = NULL;
|
|
2876 int count;
|
|
2877 int i, j;
|
|
2878
|
|
2879 /* Get drop position, modifiers and count of items */
|
|
2880 {
|
|
2881 Point point;
|
|
2882 SInt16 mouseUpModifiers;
|
|
2883 UInt16 countItem;
|
|
2884
|
|
2885 GetDragMouse(theDrag, &point, NULL);
|
|
2886 GlobalToLocal(&point);
|
|
2887 x = point.h;
|
|
2888 y = point.v;
|
|
2889 GetDragModifiers(theDrag, NULL, NULL, &mouseUpModifiers);
|
|
2890 modifiers = EventModifiers2VimMouseModifiers(mouseUpModifiers);
|
|
2891 CountDragItems(theDrag, &countItem);
|
|
2892 count = countItem;
|
|
2893 }
|
|
2894
|
|
2895 fnames = (char_u **)alloc(count * sizeof(char_u *));
|
|
2896 if (fnames == NULL)
|
|
2897 return dragNotAcceptedErr;
|
|
2898
|
|
2899 /* Get file names dropped */
|
|
2900 for (i = j = 0; i < count; ++i)
|
|
2901 {
|
|
2902 DragItemRef item;
|
|
2903 OSErr err;
|
|
2904 Size size;
|
|
2905 FlavorType type = flavorTypeHFS;
|
|
2906 HFSFlavor hfsFlavor;
|
|
2907
|
|
2908 fnames[i] = NULL;
|
|
2909 GetDragItemReferenceNumber(theDrag, i + 1, &item);
|
|
2910 err = GetFlavorDataSize(theDrag, item, type, &size);
|
|
2911 if (err != noErr || size > sizeof(hfsFlavor))
|
|
2912 continue;
|
|
2913 err = GetFlavorData(theDrag, item, type, &hfsFlavor, &size, 0);
|
|
2914 if (err != noErr)
|
|
2915 continue;
|
|
2916 fnames[j++] = FullPathFromFSSpec_save(hfsFlavor.fileSpec);
|
|
2917 }
|
|
2918 count = j;
|
|
2919
|
|
2920 gui_handle_drop(x, y, modifiers, fnames, count);
|
37
|
2921
|
|
2922 /* Fake mouse event to wake from stall */
|
|
2923 PostEvent(mouseUp, 0);
|
|
2924
|
7
|
2925 return noErr;
|
|
2926 }
|
|
2927
|
|
2928 /*
|
|
2929 * Initialise the GUI. Create all the windows, set up all the call-backs
|
|
2930 * etc.
|
|
2931 */
|
|
2932 int
|
593
|
2933 gui_mch_init(void)
|
7
|
2934 {
|
|
2935 /* TODO: Move most of this stuff toward gui_mch_init */
|
|
2936 Rect windRect;
|
|
2937 MenuHandle pomme;
|
|
2938 long gestalt_rc;
|
|
2939 EventTypeSpec eventTypeSpec;
|
|
2940 EventHandlerRef mouseWheelHandlerRef;
|
168
|
2941 #ifdef USE_CARBONKEYHANDLER
|
|
2942 EventHandlerRef keyEventHandlerRef;
|
|
2943 #endif
|
|
2944
|
|
2945 if (Gestalt(gestaltSystemVersion, &gMacSystemVersion) != noErr)
|
593
|
2946 gMacSystemVersion = 0x1000; /* TODO: Default to minimum sensible value */
|
168
|
2947
|
7
|
2948 #if 1
|
|
2949 InitCursor();
|
|
2950
|
|
2951 RegisterAppearanceClient();
|
|
2952
|
|
2953 #ifdef USE_AEVENT
|
|
2954 (void) InstallAEHandlers();
|
|
2955 #endif
|
|
2956
|
593
|
2957 /* Ctrl click */
|
7
|
2958 if (Gestalt(gestaltContextualMenuAttr, &gestalt_rc) == noErr)
|
|
2959 gui.MacOSHaveCntxMenu = BitTst(&gestalt_rc, 31-gestaltContextualMenuTrapAvailable);
|
|
2960 else
|
|
2961 gui.MacOSHaveCntxMenu = false;
|
|
2962
|
|
2963 if (gui.MacOSHaveCntxMenu)
|
|
2964 gui.MacOSHaveCntxMenu = (InitContextualMenus()==noErr);
|
9
|
2965
|
|
2966 pomme = NewMenu(256, "\p\024"); /* 0x14= = Apple Menu */
|
|
2967
|
|
2968 AppendMenu(pomme, "\pAbout VIM");
|
|
2969
|
|
2970 InsertMenu(pomme, 0);
|
7
|
2971
|
|
2972 DrawMenuBar();
|
|
2973
|
|
2974
|
|
2975 #ifndef USE_OFFSETED_WINDOW
|
9
|
2976 SetRect(&windRect, 10, 48, 10+80*7 + 16, 48+24*11);
|
7
|
2977 #else
|
9
|
2978 SetRect(&windRect, 300, 40, 300+80*7 + 16, 40+24*11);
|
7
|
2979 #endif
|
|
2980
|
|
2981 gui.VimWindow = NewCWindow(nil, &windRect, "\pgVim on Macintosh", true,
|
|
2982 zoomDocProc,
|
|
2983 (WindowPtr)-1L, true, 0);
|
|
2984 InstallReceiveHandler((DragReceiveHandlerUPP)receiveHandler,
|
|
2985 gui.VimWindow, NULL);
|
9
|
2986 SetPortWindowPort(gui.VimWindow);
|
7
|
2987
|
|
2988 gui.char_width = 7;
|
|
2989 gui.char_height = 11;
|
|
2990 gui.char_ascent = 6;
|
|
2991 gui.num_rows = 24;
|
|
2992 gui.num_cols = 80;
|
|
2993 gui.in_focus = TRUE; /* For the moment -> syn. of front application */
|
|
2994
|
9
|
2995 gScrollAction = NewControlActionUPP(gui_mac_scroll_action);
|
|
2996 gScrollDrag = NewControlActionUPP(gui_mac_drag_thumb);
|
593
|
2997
|
13
|
2998 /* Install Carbon event callbacks. */
|
|
2999 (void)InstallFontPanelHandler();
|
7
|
3000
|
|
3001 dragRectEnbl = FALSE;
|
|
3002 dragRgn = NULL;
|
|
3003 dragRectControl = kCreateEmpty;
|
|
3004 cursorRgn = NewRgn();
|
|
3005 #endif
|
|
3006 /* Display any pending error messages */
|
|
3007 display_errors();
|
|
3008
|
|
3009 /* Get background/foreground colors from system */
|
|
3010 /* TODO: do the approriate call to get real defaults */
|
|
3011 gui.norm_pixel = 0x00000000;
|
|
3012 gui.back_pixel = 0x00FFFFFF;
|
|
3013
|
|
3014 /* Get the colors from the "Normal" group (set in syntax.c or in a vimrc
|
|
3015 * file). */
|
|
3016 set_normal_colors();
|
|
3017
|
|
3018 /*
|
|
3019 * Check that none of the colors are the same as the background color.
|
|
3020 * Then store the current values as the defaults.
|
|
3021 */
|
|
3022 gui_check_colors();
|
|
3023 gui.def_norm_pixel = gui.norm_pixel;
|
|
3024 gui.def_back_pixel = gui.back_pixel;
|
|
3025
|
|
3026 /* Get the colors for the highlight groups (gui_check_colors() might have
|
|
3027 * changed them) */
|
|
3028 highlight_gui_started();
|
|
3029
|
|
3030 /*
|
|
3031 * Setting the gui constants
|
|
3032 */
|
|
3033 #ifdef FEAT_MENU
|
|
3034 gui.menu_height = 0;
|
|
3035 #endif
|
|
3036 gui.scrollbar_height = gui.scrollbar_width = 15; /* cheat 1 overlap */
|
|
3037 gui.border_offset = gui.border_width = 2;
|
|
3038
|
|
3039 /* If Quartz-style text antialiasing is available (see
|
|
3040 gui_mch_draw_string() below), enable it for all font sizes. */
|
|
3041 vim_setenv((char_u *)"QDTEXT_MINSIZE", (char_u *)"1");
|
593
|
3042
|
7
|
3043 eventTypeSpec.eventClass = kEventClassMouse;
|
|
3044 eventTypeSpec.eventKind = kEventMouseWheelMoved;
|
|
3045 mouseWheelHandlerUPP = NewEventHandlerUPP(gui_mac_mouse_wheel);
|
|
3046 if (noErr != InstallApplicationEventHandler(mouseWheelHandlerUPP, 1,
|
|
3047 &eventTypeSpec, NULL, &mouseWheelHandlerRef))
|
|
3048 {
|
|
3049 mouseWheelHandlerRef = NULL;
|
|
3050 DisposeEventHandlerUPP(mouseWheelHandlerUPP);
|
|
3051 mouseWheelHandlerUPP = NULL;
|
|
3052 }
|
|
3053
|
168
|
3054 #ifdef USE_CARBONKEYHANDLER
|
|
3055 eventTypeSpec.eventClass = kEventClassTextInput;
|
|
3056 eventTypeSpec.eventKind = kEventUnicodeForKeyEvent;
|
|
3057 keyEventHandlerUPP = NewEventHandlerUPP(gui_mac_doKeyEventCarbon);
|
|
3058 if (noErr != InstallApplicationEventHandler(keyEventHandlerUPP, 1,
|
|
3059 &eventTypeSpec, NULL, &keyEventHandlerRef))
|
|
3060 {
|
|
3061 keyEventHandlerRef = NULL;
|
|
3062 DisposeEventHandlerUPP(keyEventHandlerUPP);
|
|
3063 keyEventHandlerUPP = NULL;
|
|
3064 }
|
|
3065 #endif
|
|
3066
|
|
3067 /*
|
7
|
3068 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
|
168
|
3069 set_option_value((char_u *)"encoding", 0L, (char_u *)"utf-8", 0);
|
|
3070 #endif
|
|
3071 */
|
7
|
3072
|
1106
|
3073 #ifdef FEAT_GUI_TABLINE
|
|
3074 /*
|
|
3075 * Create the tabline
|
|
3076 */
|
|
3077 initialise_tabline();
|
|
3078 #endif
|
|
3079
|
7
|
3080 /* TODO: Load bitmap if using TOOLBAR */
|
|
3081 return OK;
|
|
3082 }
|
|
3083
|
|
3084 /*
|
|
3085 * Called when the foreground or background color has been changed.
|
|
3086 */
|
|
3087 void
|
593
|
3088 gui_mch_new_colors(void)
|
7
|
3089 {
|
|
3090 /* TODO:
|
|
3091 * This proc is called when Normal is set to a value
|
|
3092 * so what msut be done? I don't know
|
|
3093 */
|
|
3094 }
|
|
3095
|
|
3096 /*
|
|
3097 * Open the GUI window which was created by a call to gui_mch_init().
|
|
3098 */
|
|
3099 int
|
593
|
3100 gui_mch_open(void)
|
7
|
3101 {
|
|
3102 ShowWindow(gui.VimWindow);
|
|
3103
|
|
3104 if (gui_win_x != -1 && gui_win_y != -1)
|
|
3105 gui_mch_set_winpos(gui_win_x, gui_win_y);
|
|
3106
|
|
3107 /*
|
|
3108 * Make the GUI the foreground process (in case it was launched
|
|
3109 * from the Terminal or via :gui).
|
|
3110 */
|
|
3111 {
|
|
3112 ProcessSerialNumber psn;
|
|
3113 if (GetCurrentProcess(&psn) == noErr)
|
|
3114 SetFrontProcess(&psn);
|
|
3115 }
|
|
3116
|
|
3117 return OK;
|
|
3118 }
|
|
3119
|
|
3120 void
|
|
3121 gui_mch_exit(int rc)
|
|
3122 {
|
|
3123 /* TODO: find out all what is missing here? */
|
|
3124 DisposeRgn(cursorRgn);
|
|
3125
|
168
|
3126 #ifdef USE_CARBONKEYHANDLER
|
|
3127 if (keyEventHandlerUPP)
|
|
3128 DisposeEventHandlerUPP(keyEventHandlerUPP);
|
|
3129 #endif
|
|
3130
|
7
|
3131 if (mouseWheelHandlerUPP != NULL)
|
|
3132 DisposeEventHandlerUPP(mouseWheelHandlerUPP);
|
|
3133
|
168
|
3134 #ifdef USE_ATSUI_DRAWING
|
842
|
3135 if (p_macatsui && gFontStyle)
|
168
|
3136 ATSUDisposeStyle(gFontStyle);
|
|
3137 #endif
|
|
3138
|
7
|
3139 /* Exit to shell? */
|
|
3140 exit(rc);
|
|
3141 }
|
|
3142
|
|
3143 /*
|
|
3144 * Get the position of the top left corner of the window.
|
|
3145 */
|
|
3146 int
|
|
3147 gui_mch_get_winpos(int *x, int *y)
|
|
3148 {
|
|
3149 /* TODO */
|
|
3150 Rect bounds;
|
|
3151 OSStatus status;
|
|
3152
|
|
3153 /* Carbon >= 1.0.2, MacOS >= 8.5 */
|
9
|
3154 status = GetWindowBounds(gui.VimWindow, kWindowStructureRgn, &bounds);
|
7
|
3155
|
|
3156 if (status != noErr)
|
|
3157 return FAIL;
|
|
3158 *x = bounds.left;
|
|
3159 *y = bounds.top;
|
|
3160 return OK;
|
|
3161 return FAIL;
|
|
3162 }
|
|
3163
|
|
3164 /*
|
|
3165 * Set the position of the top left corner of the window to the given
|
|
3166 * coordinates.
|
|
3167 */
|
|
3168 void
|
|
3169 gui_mch_set_winpos(int x, int y)
|
|
3170 {
|
|
3171 /* TODO: Should make sure the window is move within range
|
|
3172 * e.g.: y > ~16 [Menu bar], x > 0, x < screen width
|
|
3173 */
|
|
3174 MoveWindow(gui.VimWindow, x, y, TRUE);
|
|
3175 }
|
|
3176
|
|
3177 void
|
|
3178 gui_mch_set_shellsize(
|
|
3179 int width,
|
|
3180 int height,
|
|
3181 int min_width,
|
|
3182 int min_height,
|
|
3183 int base_width,
|
812
|
3184 int base_height,
|
|
3185 int direction)
|
7
|
3186 {
|
|
3187 CGrafPtr VimPort;
|
|
3188 Rect VimBound;
|
|
3189
|
|
3190 if (gui.which_scrollbars[SBAR_LEFT])
|
|
3191 {
|
9
|
3192 VimPort = GetWindowPort(gui.VimWindow);
|
|
3193 GetPortBounds(VimPort, &VimBound);
|
7
|
3194 VimBound.left = -gui.scrollbar_width; /* + 1;*/
|
9
|
3195 SetPortBounds(VimPort, &VimBound);
|
7
|
3196 /* GetWindowBounds(gui.VimWindow, kWindowGlobalPortRgn, &winPortRect); ??*/
|
|
3197 }
|
|
3198 else
|
|
3199 {
|
9
|
3200 VimPort = GetWindowPort(gui.VimWindow);
|
|
3201 GetPortBounds(VimPort, &VimBound);
|
7
|
3202 VimBound.left = 0;
|
9
|
3203 SetPortBounds(VimPort, &VimBound);
|
7
|
3204 }
|
|
3205
|
|
3206 SizeWindow(gui.VimWindow, width, height, TRUE);
|
|
3207
|
|
3208 gui_resize_shell(width, height);
|
|
3209 }
|
|
3210
|
|
3211 /*
|
|
3212 * Get the screen dimensions.
|
|
3213 * Allow 10 pixels for horizontal borders, 40 for vertical borders.
|
|
3214 * Is there no way to find out how wide the borders really are?
|
|
3215 * TODO: Add live udate of those value on suspend/resume.
|
|
3216 */
|
|
3217 void
|
593
|
3218 gui_mch_get_screen_dimensions(int *screen_w, int *screen_h)
|
7
|
3219 {
|
|
3220 GDHandle dominantDevice = GetMainDevice();
|
|
3221 Rect screenRect = (**dominantDevice).gdRect;
|
|
3222
|
|
3223 *screen_w = screenRect.right - 10;
|
|
3224 *screen_h = screenRect.bottom - 40;
|
|
3225 }
|
|
3226
|
|
3227
|
13
|
3228 /*
|
|
3229 * Open the Font Panel and wait for the user to select a font and
|
|
3230 * close the panel. Then fill the buffer pointed to by font_name with
|
|
3231 * the name and size of the selected font and return the font's handle,
|
|
3232 * or NOFONT in case of an error.
|
|
3233 */
|
|
3234 static GuiFont
|
|
3235 gui_mac_select_font(char_u *font_name)
|
|
3236 {
|
|
3237 GuiFont selected_font = NOFONT;
|
|
3238 OSStatus status;
|
|
3239 FontSelectionQDStyle curr_font;
|
|
3240
|
|
3241 /* Initialize the Font Panel with the current font. */
|
|
3242 curr_font.instance.fontFamily = gui.norm_font & 0xFFFF;
|
|
3243 curr_font.size = (gui.norm_font >> 16);
|
|
3244 /* TODO: set fontStyle once styles are supported in gui_mac_find_font() */
|
|
3245 curr_font.instance.fontStyle = 0;
|
|
3246 curr_font.hasColor = false;
|
|
3247 curr_font.version = 0; /* version number of the style structure */
|
|
3248 status = SetFontInfoForSelection(kFontSelectionQDType,
|
|
3249 /*numStyles=*/1, &curr_font, /*eventTarget=*/NULL);
|
|
3250
|
|
3251 gFontPanelInfo.family = curr_font.instance.fontFamily;
|
|
3252 gFontPanelInfo.style = curr_font.instance.fontStyle;
|
|
3253 gFontPanelInfo.size = curr_font.size;
|
|
3254
|
|
3255 /* Pop up the Font Panel. */
|
|
3256 status = FPShowHideFontPanel();
|
|
3257 if (status == noErr)
|
|
3258 {
|
|
3259 /*
|
|
3260 * The Font Panel is modeless. We really need it to be modal,
|
|
3261 * so we spin in an event loop until the panel is closed.
|
|
3262 */
|
|
3263 gFontPanelInfo.isPanelVisible = true;
|
|
3264 while (gFontPanelInfo.isPanelVisible)
|
|
3265 {
|
|
3266 EventRecord e;
|
|
3267 WaitNextEvent(everyEvent, &e, /*sleep=*/20, /*mouseRgn=*/NULL);
|
|
3268 }
|
|
3269
|
|
3270 GetFontPanelSelection(font_name);
|
|
3271 selected_font = gui_mac_find_font(font_name);
|
|
3272 }
|
|
3273 return selected_font;
|
|
3274 }
|
|
3275
|
7
|
3276
|
|
3277 /*
|
|
3278 * Initialise vim to use the font with the given name. Return FAIL if the font
|
|
3279 * could not be loaded, OK otherwise.
|
|
3280 */
|
|
3281 int
|
593
|
3282 gui_mch_init_font(char_u *font_name, int fontset)
|
7
|
3283 {
|
|
3284 /* TODO: Add support for bold italic underline proportional etc... */
|
|
3285 Str255 suggestedFont = "\pMonaco";
|
170
|
3286 int suggestedSize = 10;
|
7
|
3287 FontInfo font_info;
|
|
3288 short font_id;
|
|
3289 GuiFont font;
|
37
|
3290 char_u used_font_name[512];
|
7
|
3291
|
168
|
3292 #ifdef USE_ATSUI_DRAWING
|
842
|
3293 if (p_macatsui && gFontStyle == NULL)
|
168
|
3294 {
|
|
3295 if (ATSUCreateStyle(&gFontStyle) != noErr)
|
|
3296 gFontStyle = NULL;
|
|
3297 }
|
|
3298 #endif
|
|
3299
|
7
|
3300 if (font_name == NULL)
|
|
3301 {
|
|
3302 /* First try to get the suggested font */
|
|
3303 GetFNum(suggestedFont, &font_id);
|
|
3304
|
|
3305 if (font_id == 0)
|
|
3306 {
|
|
3307 /* Then pickup the standard application font */
|
|
3308 font_id = GetAppFont();
|
37
|
3309 STRCPY(used_font_name, "default");
|
7
|
3310 }
|
37
|
3311 else
|
|
3312 STRCPY(used_font_name, "Monaco");
|
7
|
3313 font = (suggestedSize << 16) + ((long) font_id & 0xFFFF);
|
|
3314 }
|
13
|
3315 else if (STRCMP(font_name, "*") == 0)
|
|
3316 {
|
37
|
3317 char_u *new_p_guifont;
|
|
3318
|
|
3319 font = gui_mac_select_font(used_font_name);
|
13
|
3320 if (font == NOFONT)
|
|
3321 return FAIL;
|
|
3322
|
|
3323 /* Set guifont to the name of the selected font. */
|
37
|
3324 new_p_guifont = alloc(STRLEN(used_font_name) + 1);
|
13
|
3325 if (new_p_guifont != NULL)
|
|
3326 {
|
37
|
3327 STRCPY(new_p_guifont, used_font_name);
|
13
|
3328 vim_free(p_guifont);
|
|
3329 p_guifont = new_p_guifont;
|
|
3330 /* Replace spaces in the font name with underscores. */
|
|
3331 for ( ; *new_p_guifont; ++new_p_guifont)
|
|
3332 {
|
|
3333 if (*new_p_guifont == ' ')
|
|
3334 *new_p_guifont = '_';
|
|
3335 }
|
|
3336 }
|
|
3337 }
|
7
|
3338 else
|
|
3339 {
|
9
|
3340 font = gui_mac_find_font(font_name);
|
418
|
3341 vim_strncpy(used_font_name, font_name, sizeof(used_font_name) - 1);
|
7
|
3342
|
|
3343 if (font == NOFONT)
|
|
3344 return FAIL;
|
|
3345 }
|
37
|
3346
|
7
|
3347 gui.norm_font = font;
|
|
3348
|
37
|
3349 hl_set_font_name(used_font_name);
|
|
3350
|
9
|
3351 TextSize(font >> 16);
|
|
3352 TextFont(font & 0xFFFF);
|
|
3353
|
189
|
3354 GetFontInfo(&font_info);
|
|
3355
|
|
3356 gui.char_ascent = font_info.ascent;
|
|
3357 gui.char_width = CharWidth('_');
|
|
3358 gui.char_height = font_info.ascent + font_info.descent + p_linespace;
|
|
3359
|
168
|
3360 #ifdef USE_ATSUI_DRAWING
|
|
3361 ATSUFontID fontID;
|
|
3362 Fixed fontSize;
|
|
3363 ATSStyleRenderingOptions fontOptions;
|
|
3364
|
842
|
3365 if (p_macatsui && gFontStyle)
|
168
|
3366 {
|
|
3367 fontID = font & 0xFFFF;
|
|
3368 fontSize = Long2Fix(font >> 16);
|
|
3369
|
|
3370 /* No antialiasing by default (do not attempt to touch antialising
|
|
3371 * options on pre-Jaguar) */
|
|
3372 fontOptions =
|
|
3373 (gMacSystemVersion >= 0x1020) ?
|
|
3374 kATSStyleNoAntiAliasing :
|
|
3375 kATSStyleNoOptions;
|
|
3376
|
|
3377 ATSUAttributeTag attribTags[] =
|
|
3378 {
|
|
3379 kATSUFontTag, kATSUSizeTag, kATSUStyleRenderingOptionsTag,
|
|
3380 kATSUMaxATSUITagValue+1
|
|
3381 };
|
|
3382 ByteCount attribSizes[] =
|
|
3383 {
|
|
3384 sizeof(ATSUFontID), sizeof(Fixed),
|
|
3385 sizeof(ATSStyleRenderingOptions), sizeof font
|
|
3386 };
|
|
3387 ATSUAttributeValuePtr attribValues[] =
|
|
3388 {
|
|
3389 &fontID, &fontSize, &fontOptions, &font
|
|
3390 };
|
|
3391
|
|
3392 /* Convert font id to ATSUFontID */
|
|
3393 if (FMGetFontFromFontFamilyInstance(fontID, 0, &fontID, NULL) == noErr)
|
|
3394 {
|
|
3395 if (ATSUSetAttributes(gFontStyle,
|
|
3396 (sizeof attribTags)/sizeof(ATSUAttributeTag),
|
|
3397 attribTags, attribSizes, attribValues) != noErr)
|
|
3398 {
|
|
3399 ATSUDisposeStyle(gFontStyle);
|
|
3400 gFontStyle = NULL;
|
|
3401 }
|
|
3402 }
|
|
3403 }
|
|
3404 #endif
|
|
3405
|
7
|
3406 return OK;
|
|
3407 }
|
|
3408
|
444
|
3409 /*
|
|
3410 * Adjust gui.char_height (after 'linespace' was changed).
|
|
3411 */
|
7
|
3412 int
|
593
|
3413 gui_mch_adjust_charheight(void)
|
7
|
3414 {
|
|
3415 FontInfo font_info;
|
|
3416
|
9
|
3417 GetFontInfo(&font_info);
|
7
|
3418 gui.char_height = font_info.ascent + font_info.descent + p_linespace;
|
|
3419 gui.char_ascent = font_info.ascent + p_linespace / 2;
|
|
3420 return OK;
|
|
3421 }
|
|
3422
|
|
3423 /*
|
|
3424 * Get a font structure for highlighting.
|
|
3425 */
|
|
3426 GuiFont
|
593
|
3427 gui_mch_get_font(char_u *name, int giveErrorIfMissing)
|
7
|
3428 {
|
|
3429 GuiFont font;
|
|
3430
|
|
3431 font = gui_mac_find_font(name);
|
|
3432
|
|
3433 if (font == NOFONT)
|
|
3434 {
|
|
3435 if (giveErrorIfMissing)
|
|
3436 EMSG2(_(e_font), name);
|
|
3437 return NOFONT;
|
|
3438 }
|
|
3439 /*
|
|
3440 * TODO : Accept only monospace
|
|
3441 */
|
|
3442
|
|
3443 return font;
|
|
3444 }
|
|
3445
|
44
|
3446 #if defined(FEAT_EVAL) || defined(PROTO)
|
7
|
3447 /*
|
37
|
3448 * Return the name of font "font" in allocated memory.
|
|
3449 * Don't know how to get the actual name, thus use the provided name.
|
|
3450 */
|
|
3451 char_u *
|
593
|
3452 gui_mch_get_fontname(GuiFont font, char_u *name)
|
37
|
3453 {
|
|
3454 if (name == NULL)
|
|
3455 return NULL;
|
|
3456 return vim_strsave(name);
|
|
3457 }
|
44
|
3458 #endif
|
37
|
3459
|
|
3460 /*
|
7
|
3461 * Set the current text font.
|
|
3462 */
|
|
3463 void
|
593
|
3464 gui_mch_set_font(GuiFont font)
|
7
|
3465 {
|
168
|
3466 #ifdef USE_ATSUI_DRAWING
|
|
3467 GuiFont currFont;
|
|
3468 ByteCount actualFontByteCount;
|
|
3469 ATSUFontID fontID;
|
|
3470 Fixed fontSize;
|
|
3471 ATSStyleRenderingOptions fontOptions;
|
|
3472
|
842
|
3473 if (p_macatsui && gFontStyle)
|
168
|
3474 {
|
|
3475 /* Avoid setting same font again */
|
|
3476 if (ATSUGetAttribute(gFontStyle, kATSUMaxATSUITagValue+1, sizeof font,
|
|
3477 &currFont, &actualFontByteCount) == noErr &&
|
|
3478 actualFontByteCount == (sizeof font))
|
|
3479 {
|
|
3480 if (currFont == font)
|
|
3481 return;
|
|
3482 }
|
|
3483
|
|
3484 fontID = font & 0xFFFF;
|
|
3485 fontSize = Long2Fix(font >> 16);
|
|
3486 /* Respect p_antialias setting only for wide font.
|
|
3487 * The reason for doing this at the moment is a bit complicated,
|
|
3488 * but it's mainly because a) latin (non-wide) aliased fonts
|
|
3489 * look bad in OS X 10.3.x and below (due to a bug in ATS), and
|
|
3490 * b) wide multibyte input does not suffer from that problem. */
|
593
|
3491 /*fontOptions =
|
168
|
3492 (p_antialias && (font == gui.wide_font)) ?
|
|
3493 kATSStyleNoOptions : kATSStyleNoAntiAliasing;
|
593
|
3494 */
|
|
3495 /*fontOptions = kATSStyleAntiAliasing;*/
|
168
|
3496
|
|
3497 ATSUAttributeTag attribTags[] =
|
|
3498 {
|
|
3499 kATSUFontTag, kATSUSizeTag, kATSUStyleRenderingOptionsTag,
|
|
3500 kATSUMaxATSUITagValue+1
|
|
3501 };
|
|
3502 ByteCount attribSizes[] =
|
|
3503 {
|
|
3504 sizeof(ATSUFontID), sizeof(Fixed),
|
|
3505 sizeof(ATSStyleRenderingOptions), sizeof font
|
|
3506 };
|
|
3507 ATSUAttributeValuePtr attribValues[] =
|
|
3508 {
|
|
3509 &fontID, &fontSize, &fontOptions, &font
|
|
3510 };
|
|
3511
|
|
3512 if (FMGetFontFromFontFamilyInstance(fontID, 0, &fontID, NULL) == noErr)
|
|
3513 {
|
|
3514 if (ATSUSetAttributes(gFontStyle,
|
|
3515 (sizeof attribTags)/sizeof(ATSUAttributeTag),
|
|
3516 attribTags, attribSizes, attribValues) != noErr)
|
|
3517 {
|
842
|
3518 # ifndef NDEBUG
|
168
|
3519 fprintf(stderr, "couldn't set font style\n");
|
842
|
3520 # endif
|
168
|
3521 ATSUDisposeStyle(gFontStyle);
|
|
3522 gFontStyle = NULL;
|
|
3523 }
|
|
3524 }
|
|
3525
|
|
3526 }
|
|
3527
|
842
|
3528 if (p_macatsui && !gIsFontFallbackSet)
|
168
|
3529 {
|
|
3530 /* Setup automatic font substitution. The user's guifontwide
|
|
3531 * is tried first, then the system tries other fonts. */
|
|
3532 /*
|
|
3533 ATSUAttributeTag fallbackTags[] = { kATSULineFontFallbacksTag };
|
|
3534 ByteCount fallbackSizes[] = { sizeof(ATSUFontFallbacks) };
|
|
3535 ATSUCreateFontFallbacks(&gFontFallbacks);
|
|
3536 ATSUSetObjFontFallbacks(gFontFallbacks, );
|
|
3537 */
|
|
3538 if (gui.wide_font)
|
|
3539 {
|
|
3540 ATSUFontID fallbackFonts;
|
|
3541 gIsFontFallbackSet = TRUE;
|
|
3542
|
|
3543 if (FMGetFontFromFontFamilyInstance(
|
|
3544 (gui.wide_font & 0xFFFF),
|
|
3545 0,
|
|
3546 &fallbackFonts,
|
|
3547 NULL) == noErr)
|
|
3548 {
|
|
3549 ATSUSetFontFallbacks((sizeof fallbackFonts)/sizeof(ATSUFontID), &fallbackFonts, kATSUSequentialFallbacksPreferred);
|
|
3550 }
|
|
3551 /*
|
|
3552 ATSUAttributeValuePtr fallbackValues[] = { };
|
|
3553 */
|
|
3554 }
|
|
3555 }
|
|
3556 #endif
|
7
|
3557 TextSize(font >> 16);
|
|
3558 TextFont(font & 0xFFFF);
|
|
3559 }
|
|
3560
|
|
3561 /*
|
|
3562 * If a font is not going to be used, free its structure.
|
|
3563 */
|
|
3564 void
|
|
3565 gui_mch_free_font(font)
|
|
3566 GuiFont font;
|
|
3567 {
|
|
3568 /*
|
|
3569 * Free font when "font" is not 0.
|
|
3570 * Nothing to do in the current implementation, since
|
|
3571 * nothing is allocated for each font used.
|
|
3572 */
|
|
3573 }
|
|
3574
|
|
3575 static int
|
593
|
3576 hex_digit(int c)
|
7
|
3577 {
|
|
3578 if (isdigit(c))
|
|
3579 return c - '0';
|
|
3580 c = TOLOWER_ASC(c);
|
|
3581 if (c >= 'a' && c <= 'f')
|
|
3582 return c - 'a' + 10;
|
|
3583 return -1000;
|
|
3584 }
|
|
3585
|
|
3586 /*
|
|
3587 * Return the Pixel value (color) for the given color name. This routine was
|
|
3588 * pretty much taken from example code in the Silicon Graphics OSF/Motif
|
|
3589 * Programmer's Guide.
|
|
3590 * Return INVALCOLOR when failed.
|
|
3591 */
|
|
3592 guicolor_T
|
593
|
3593 gui_mch_get_color(char_u *name)
|
7
|
3594 {
|
|
3595 /* TODO: Add support for the new named color of MacOS 8
|
|
3596 */
|
|
3597 RGBColor MacColor;
|
|
3598 // guicolor_T color = 0;
|
|
3599
|
|
3600 typedef struct guicolor_tTable
|
|
3601 {
|
|
3602 char *name;
|
|
3603 guicolor_T color;
|
|
3604 } guicolor_tTable;
|
|
3605
|
|
3606 /*
|
|
3607 * The comment at the end of each line is the source
|
|
3608 * (Mac, Window, Unix) and the number is the unix rgb.txt value
|
|
3609 */
|
|
3610 static guicolor_tTable table[] =
|
|
3611 {
|
|
3612 {"Black", RGB(0x00, 0x00, 0x00)},
|
|
3613 {"darkgray", RGB(0x80, 0x80, 0x80)}, /*W*/
|
|
3614 {"darkgrey", RGB(0x80, 0x80, 0x80)}, /*W*/
|
|
3615 {"Gray", RGB(0xC0, 0xC0, 0xC0)}, /*W*/
|
|
3616 {"Grey", RGB(0xC0, 0xC0, 0xC0)}, /*W*/
|
|
3617 {"lightgray", RGB(0xE0, 0xE0, 0xE0)}, /*W*/
|
|
3618 {"lightgrey", RGB(0xE0, 0xE0, 0xE0)}, /*W*/
|
834
|
3619 {"gray10", RGB(0x1A, 0x1A, 0x1A)}, /*W*/
|
|
3620 {"grey10", RGB(0x1A, 0x1A, 0x1A)}, /*W*/
|
|
3621 {"gray20", RGB(0x33, 0x33, 0x33)}, /*W*/
|
|
3622 {"grey20", RGB(0x33, 0x33, 0x33)}, /*W*/
|
|
3623 {"gray30", RGB(0x4D, 0x4D, 0x4D)}, /*W*/
|
|
3624 {"grey30", RGB(0x4D, 0x4D, 0x4D)}, /*W*/
|
|
3625 {"gray40", RGB(0x66, 0x66, 0x66)}, /*W*/
|
|
3626 {"grey40", RGB(0x66, 0x66, 0x66)}, /*W*/
|
|
3627 {"gray50", RGB(0x7F, 0x7F, 0x7F)}, /*W*/
|
|
3628 {"grey50", RGB(0x7F, 0x7F, 0x7F)}, /*W*/
|
|
3629 {"gray60", RGB(0x99, 0x99, 0x99)}, /*W*/
|
|
3630 {"grey60", RGB(0x99, 0x99, 0x99)}, /*W*/
|
|
3631 {"gray70", RGB(0xB3, 0xB3, 0xB3)}, /*W*/
|
|
3632 {"grey70", RGB(0xB3, 0xB3, 0xB3)}, /*W*/
|
|
3633 {"gray80", RGB(0xCC, 0xCC, 0xCC)}, /*W*/
|
|
3634 {"grey80", RGB(0xCC, 0xCC, 0xCC)}, /*W*/
|
818
|
3635 {"gray90", RGB(0xE5, 0xE5, 0xE5)}, /*W*/
|
|
3636 {"grey90", RGB(0xE5, 0xE5, 0xE5)}, /*W*/
|
7
|
3637 {"white", RGB(0xFF, 0xFF, 0xFF)},
|
|
3638 {"darkred", RGB(0x80, 0x00, 0x00)}, /*W*/
|
|
3639 {"red", RGB(0xDD, 0x08, 0x06)}, /*M*/
|
|
3640 {"lightred", RGB(0xFF, 0xA0, 0xA0)}, /*W*/
|
|
3641 {"DarkBlue", RGB(0x00, 0x00, 0x80)}, /*W*/
|
|
3642 {"Blue", RGB(0x00, 0x00, 0xD4)}, /*M*/
|
|
3643 {"lightblue", RGB(0xA0, 0xA0, 0xFF)}, /*W*/
|
|
3644 {"DarkGreen", RGB(0x00, 0x80, 0x00)}, /*W*/
|
|
3645 {"Green", RGB(0x00, 0x64, 0x11)}, /*M*/
|
|
3646 {"lightgreen", RGB(0xA0, 0xFF, 0xA0)}, /*W*/
|
|
3647 {"DarkCyan", RGB(0x00, 0x80, 0x80)}, /*W ?0x307D7E */
|
|
3648 {"cyan", RGB(0x02, 0xAB, 0xEA)}, /*M*/
|
|
3649 {"lightcyan", RGB(0xA0, 0xFF, 0xFF)}, /*W*/
|
|
3650 {"darkmagenta", RGB(0x80, 0x00, 0x80)}, /*W*/
|
|
3651 {"magenta", RGB(0xF2, 0x08, 0x84)}, /*M*/
|
|
3652 {"lightmagenta",RGB(0xF0, 0xA0, 0xF0)}, /*W*/
|
|
3653 {"brown", RGB(0x80, 0x40, 0x40)}, /*W*/
|
|
3654 {"yellow", RGB(0xFC, 0xF3, 0x05)}, /*M*/
|
|
3655 {"lightyellow", RGB(0xFF, 0xFF, 0xA0)}, /*M*/
|
308
|
3656 {"darkyellow", RGB(0xBB, 0xBB, 0x00)}, /*U*/
|
7
|
3657 {"SeaGreen", RGB(0x2E, 0x8B, 0x57)}, /*W 0x4E8975 */
|
|
3658 {"orange", RGB(0xFC, 0x80, 0x00)}, /*W 0xF87A17 */
|
|
3659 {"Purple", RGB(0xA0, 0x20, 0xF0)}, /*W 0x8e35e5 */
|
|
3660 {"SlateBlue", RGB(0x6A, 0x5A, 0xCD)}, /*W 0x737CA1 */
|
|
3661 {"Violet", RGB(0x8D, 0x38, 0xC9)}, /*U*/
|
|
3662 };
|
|
3663
|
|
3664 int r, g, b;
|
|
3665 int i;
|
|
3666
|
|
3667 if (name[0] == '#' && strlen((char *) name) == 7)
|
|
3668 {
|
|
3669 /* Name is in "#rrggbb" format */
|
|
3670 r = hex_digit(name[1]) * 16 + hex_digit(name[2]);
|
|
3671 g = hex_digit(name[3]) * 16 + hex_digit(name[4]);
|
|
3672 b = hex_digit(name[5]) * 16 + hex_digit(name[6]);
|
|
3673 if (r < 0 || g < 0 || b < 0)
|
|
3674 return INVALCOLOR;
|
|
3675 return RGB(r, g, b);
|
|
3676 }
|
|
3677 else
|
|
3678 {
|
9
|
3679 if (STRICMP(name, "hilite") == 0)
|
7
|
3680 {
|
9
|
3681 LMGetHiliteRGB(&MacColor);
|
|
3682 return (RGB(MacColor.red >> 8, MacColor.green >> 8, MacColor.blue >> 8));
|
7
|
3683 }
|
|
3684 /* Check if the name is one of the colors we know */
|
|
3685 for (i = 0; i < sizeof(table) / sizeof(table[0]); i++)
|
|
3686 if (STRICMP(name, table[i].name) == 0)
|
|
3687 return table[i].color;
|
|
3688 }
|
|
3689
|
|
3690 /*
|
|
3691 * Last attempt. Look in the file "$VIM/rgb.txt".
|
|
3692 */
|
|
3693 {
|
|
3694 #define LINE_LEN 100
|
|
3695 FILE *fd;
|
|
3696 char line[LINE_LEN];
|
|
3697 char_u *fname;
|
|
3698
|
|
3699 fname = expand_env_save((char_u *)"$VIMRUNTIME/rgb.txt");
|
|
3700 if (fname == NULL)
|
|
3701 return INVALCOLOR;
|
|
3702
|
|
3703 fd = fopen((char *)fname, "rt");
|
|
3704 vim_free(fname);
|
|
3705 if (fd == NULL)
|
|
3706 return INVALCOLOR;
|
|
3707
|
|
3708 while (!feof(fd))
|
|
3709 {
|
|
3710 int len;
|
|
3711 int pos;
|
|
3712 char *color;
|
|
3713
|
|
3714 fgets(line, LINE_LEN, fd);
|
|
3715 len = strlen(line);
|
|
3716
|
|
3717 if (len <= 1 || line[len-1] != '\n')
|
|
3718 continue;
|
|
3719
|
|
3720 line[len-1] = '\0';
|
|
3721
|
|
3722 i = sscanf(line, "%d %d %d %n", &r, &g, &b, &pos);
|
|
3723 if (i != 3)
|
|
3724 continue;
|
|
3725
|
|
3726 color = line + pos;
|
|
3727
|
|
3728 if (STRICMP(color, name) == 0)
|
|
3729 {
|
|
3730 fclose(fd);
|
|
3731 return (guicolor_T) RGB(r, g, b);
|
|
3732 }
|
|
3733 }
|
|
3734 fclose(fd);
|
|
3735 }
|
|
3736
|
|
3737 return INVALCOLOR;
|
|
3738 }
|
|
3739
|
|
3740 /*
|
|
3741 * Set the current text foreground color.
|
|
3742 */
|
|
3743 void
|
593
|
3744 gui_mch_set_fg_color(guicolor_T color)
|
7
|
3745 {
|
|
3746 RGBColor TheColor;
|
|
3747
|
|
3748 TheColor.red = Red(color) * 0x0101;
|
|
3749 TheColor.green = Green(color) * 0x0101;
|
|
3750 TheColor.blue = Blue(color) * 0x0101;
|
|
3751
|
9
|
3752 RGBForeColor(&TheColor);
|
7
|
3753 }
|
|
3754
|
|
3755 /*
|
|
3756 * Set the current text background color.
|
|
3757 */
|
|
3758 void
|
593
|
3759 gui_mch_set_bg_color(guicolor_T color)
|
7
|
3760 {
|
|
3761 RGBColor TheColor;
|
|
3762
|
|
3763 TheColor.red = Red(color) * 0x0101;
|
|
3764 TheColor.green = Green(color) * 0x0101;
|
|
3765 TheColor.blue = Blue(color) * 0x0101;
|
|
3766
|
9
|
3767 RGBBackColor(&TheColor);
|
7
|
3768 }
|
|
3769
|
563
|
3770 RGBColor specialColor;
|
|
3771
|
212
|
3772 /*
|
563
|
3773 * Set the current text special color.
|
212
|
3774 */
|
|
3775 void
|
593
|
3776 gui_mch_set_sp_color(guicolor_T color)
|
212
|
3777 {
|
563
|
3778 specialColor.red = Red(color) * 0x0101;
|
|
3779 specialColor.green = Green(color) * 0x0101;
|
|
3780 specialColor.blue = Blue(color) * 0x0101;
|
|
3781 }
|
|
3782
|
|
3783 /*
|
|
3784 * Draw undercurl at the bottom of the character cell.
|
|
3785 */
|
|
3786 static void
|
|
3787 draw_undercurl(int flags, int row, int col, int cells)
|
|
3788 {
|
856
|
3789 int x;
|
|
3790 int offset;
|
|
3791 const static int val[8] = {1, 0, 0, 0, 1, 2, 2, 2 };
|
|
3792 int y = FILL_Y(row + 1) - 1;
|
563
|
3793
|
|
3794 RGBForeColor(&specialColor);
|
|
3795
|
|
3796 offset = val[FILL_X(col) % 8];
|
|
3797 MoveTo(FILL_X(col), y - offset);
|
|
3798
|
593
|
3799 for (x = FILL_X(col); x < FILL_X(col + cells); ++x)
|
563
|
3800 {
|
593
|
3801 offset = val[x % 8];
|
|
3802 LineTo(x, y - offset);
|
563
|
3803 }
|
212
|
3804 }
|
|
3805
|
593
|
3806
|
|
3807 static void
|
|
3808 draw_string_QD(int row, int col, char_u *s, int len, int flags)
|
7
|
3809 {
|
|
3810 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
|
|
3811 char_u *tofree = NULL;
|
|
3812
|
|
3813 if (output_conv.vc_type != CONV_NONE)
|
|
3814 {
|
|
3815 tofree = string_convert(&output_conv, s, &len);
|
|
3816 if (tofree != NULL)
|
|
3817 s = tofree;
|
|
3818 }
|
|
3819 #endif
|
593
|
3820
|
7
|
3821 /*
|
|
3822 * On OS X, try using Quartz-style text antialiasing.
|
|
3823 */
|
189
|
3824 if (gMacSystemVersion >= 0x1020)
|
7
|
3825 {
|
|
3826 /* Quartz antialiasing is available only in OS 10.2 and later. */
|
|
3827 UInt32 qd_flags = (p_antialias ?
|
|
3828 kQDUseCGTextRendering | kQDUseCGTextMetrics : 0);
|
168
|
3829 QDSwapTextFlags(qd_flags);
|
7
|
3830 }
|
|
3831
|
36
|
3832 /*
|
|
3833 * When antialiasing we're using srcOr mode, we have to clear the block
|
|
3834 * before drawing the text.
|
|
3835 * Also needed when 'linespace' is non-zero to remove the cursor and
|
|
3836 * underlining.
|
|
3837 * But not when drawing transparently.
|
|
3838 * The following is like calling gui_mch_clear_block(row, col, row, col +
|
|
3839 * len - 1), but without setting the bg color to gui.back_pixel.
|
|
3840 */
|
189
|
3841 if (((gMacSystemVersion >= 0x1020 && p_antialias) || p_linespace != 0)
|
36
|
3842 && !(flags & DRAW_TRANSP))
|
|
3843 {
|
|
3844 Rect rc;
|
|
3845
|
|
3846 rc.left = FILL_X(col);
|
|
3847 rc.top = FILL_Y(row);
|
168
|
3848 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
|
|
3849 /* Multibyte computation taken from gui_w32.c */
|
|
3850 if (has_mbyte)
|
|
3851 {
|
|
3852 int cell_len = 0;
|
|
3853 int n;
|
|
3854
|
|
3855 /* Compute the length in display cells. */
|
|
3856 for (n = 0; n < len; n += MB_BYTE2LEN(s[n]))
|
|
3857 cell_len += (*mb_ptr2cells)(s + n);
|
|
3858 rc.right = FILL_X(col + cell_len);
|
|
3859 }
|
|
3860 else
|
|
3861 #endif
|
36
|
3862 rc.right = FILL_X(col + len) + (col + len == Columns);
|
|
3863 rc.bottom = FILL_Y(row + 1);
|
|
3864 EraseRect(&rc);
|
|
3865 }
|
|
3866
|
189
|
3867 if (gMacSystemVersion >= 0x1020 && p_antialias)
|
7
|
3868 {
|
|
3869 StyleParameter face;
|
|
3870
|
|
3871 face = normal;
|
|
3872 if (flags & DRAW_BOLD)
|
|
3873 face |= bold;
|
|
3874 if (flags & DRAW_UNDERL)
|
|
3875 face |= underline;
|
|
3876 TextFace(face);
|
|
3877
|
|
3878 /* Quartz antialiasing works only in srcOr transfer mode. */
|
|
3879 TextMode(srcOr);
|
|
3880
|
|
3881 MoveTo(TEXT_X(col), TEXT_Y(row));
|
|
3882 DrawText((char*)s, 0, len);
|
|
3883 }
|
|
3884 else
|
|
3885 {
|
|
3886 /* Use old-style, non-antialiased QuickDraw text rendering. */
|
9
|
3887 TextMode(srcCopy);
|
|
3888 TextFace(normal);
|
7
|
3889
|
|
3890 /* SelectFont(hdc, gui.currFont); */
|
|
3891
|
|
3892 if (flags & DRAW_TRANSP)
|
|
3893 {
|
9
|
3894 TextMode(srcOr);
|
7
|
3895 }
|
|
3896
|
9
|
3897 MoveTo(TEXT_X(col), TEXT_Y(row));
|
593
|
3898 DrawText((char *)s, 0, len);
|
|
3899
|
|
3900 if (flags & DRAW_BOLD)
|
|
3901 {
|
|
3902 TextMode(srcOr);
|
|
3903 MoveTo(TEXT_X(col) + 1, TEXT_Y(row));
|
|
3904 DrawText((char *)s, 0, len);
|
|
3905 }
|
|
3906
|
|
3907 if (flags & DRAW_UNDERL)
|
|
3908 {
|
|
3909 MoveTo(FILL_X(col), FILL_Y(row + 1) - 1);
|
|
3910 LineTo(FILL_X(col + len) - 1, FILL_Y(row + 1) - 1);
|
|
3911 }
|
|
3912 }
|
|
3913
|
|
3914 if (flags & DRAW_UNDERC)
|
|
3915 draw_undercurl(flags, row, col, len);
|
|
3916
|
|
3917 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
|
|
3918 vim_free(tofree);
|
|
3919 #endif
|
|
3920 }
|
|
3921
|
842
|
3922 #ifdef USE_ATSUI_DRAWING
|
593
|
3923
|
|
3924 static void
|
|
3925 draw_string_ATSUI(int row, int col, char_u *s, int len, int flags)
|
|
3926 {
|
|
3927 /* ATSUI requires utf-16 strings */
|
|
3928 UniCharCount utf16_len;
|
|
3929 UniChar *tofree = mac_enc_to_utf16(s, len, (size_t *)&utf16_len);
|
|
3930 utf16_len /= sizeof(UniChar);
|
|
3931
|
|
3932 /* - ATSUI automatically antialiases text (Someone)
|
|
3933 * - for some reason it does not work... (Jussi) */
|
|
3934
|
|
3935 /*
|
|
3936 * When antialiasing we're using srcOr mode, we have to clear the block
|
|
3937 * before drawing the text.
|
|
3938 * Also needed when 'linespace' is non-zero to remove the cursor and
|
|
3939 * underlining.
|
|
3940 * But not when drawing transparently.
|
|
3941 * The following is like calling gui_mch_clear_block(row, col, row, col +
|
|
3942 * len - 1), but without setting the bg color to gui.back_pixel.
|
|
3943 */
|
|
3944 if ((flags & DRAW_TRANSP) == 0)
|
|
3945 {
|
|
3946 Rect rc;
|
|
3947
|
|
3948 rc.left = FILL_X(col);
|
|
3949 rc.top = FILL_Y(row);
|
|
3950 /* Multibyte computation taken from gui_w32.c */
|
|
3951 if (has_mbyte)
|
|
3952 {
|
|
3953 int cell_len = 0;
|
|
3954 int n;
|
|
3955
|
|
3956 /* Compute the length in display cells. */
|
|
3957 for (n = 0; n < len; n += MB_BYTE2LEN(s[n]))
|
|
3958 cell_len += (*mb_ptr2cells)(s + n);
|
|
3959 rc.right = FILL_X(col + cell_len);
|
|
3960 }
|
|
3961 else
|
|
3962 rc.right = FILL_X(col + len) + (col + len == Columns);
|
|
3963
|
|
3964 rc.bottom = FILL_Y(row + 1);
|
|
3965 EraseRect(&rc);
|
|
3966 }
|
|
3967
|
|
3968 {
|
|
3969 /* Use old-style, non-antialiased QuickDraw text rendering. */
|
|
3970 TextMode(srcCopy);
|
|
3971 TextFace(normal);
|
|
3972
|
|
3973 /* SelectFont(hdc, gui.currFont); */
|
|
3974
|
|
3975 if (flags & DRAW_TRANSP)
|
|
3976 {
|
|
3977 TextMode(srcOr);
|
|
3978 }
|
|
3979
|
|
3980 MoveTo(TEXT_X(col), TEXT_Y(row));
|
168
|
3981 ATSUTextLayout textLayout;
|
|
3982
|
|
3983 if (ATSUCreateTextLayoutWithTextPtr(tofree,
|
|
3984 kATSUFromTextBeginning, kATSUToTextEnd,
|
|
3985 utf16_len,
|
|
3986 (gFontStyle ? 1 : 0), &utf16_len,
|
|
3987 (gFontStyle ? &gFontStyle : NULL),
|
|
3988 &textLayout) == noErr)
|
|
3989 {
|
|
3990 ATSUSetTransientFontMatching(textLayout, TRUE);
|
|
3991
|
|
3992 ATSUDrawText(textLayout,
|
|
3993 kATSUFromTextBeginning, kATSUToTextEnd,
|
|
3994 kATSUUseGrafPortPenLoc, kATSUUseGrafPortPenLoc);
|
|
3995
|
|
3996 ATSUDisposeTextLayout(textLayout);
|
|
3997 }
|
7
|
3998 }
|
|
3999
|
563
|
4000 if (flags & DRAW_UNDERC)
|
|
4001 draw_undercurl(flags, row, col, len);
|
|
4002
|
7
|
4003 vim_free(tofree);
|
593
|
4004 }
|
|
4005 #endif
|
|
4006
|
|
4007 void
|
|
4008 gui_mch_draw_string(int row, int col, char_u *s, int len, int flags)
|
|
4009 {
|
|
4010 #if defined(USE_ATSUI_DRAWING)
|
842
|
4011 if (p_macatsui)
|
|
4012 draw_string_ATSUI(row, col, s, len, flags);
|
|
4013 else
|
7
|
4014 #endif
|
842
|
4015 draw_string_QD(row, col, s, len, flags);
|
7
|
4016 }
|
|
4017
|
|
4018 /*
|
|
4019 * Return OK if the key with the termcap name "name" is supported.
|
|
4020 */
|
|
4021 int
|
593
|
4022 gui_mch_haskey(char_u *name)
|
7
|
4023 {
|
|
4024 int i;
|
|
4025
|
|
4026 for (i = 0; special_keys[i].key_sym != (KeySym)0; i++)
|
|
4027 if (name[0] == special_keys[i].vim_code0 &&
|
|
4028 name[1] == special_keys[i].vim_code1)
|
|
4029 return OK;
|
|
4030 return FAIL;
|
|
4031 }
|
|
4032
|
|
4033 void
|
593
|
4034 gui_mch_beep(void)
|
7
|
4035 {
|
9
|
4036 SysBeep(1); /* Should this be 0? (????) */
|
7
|
4037 }
|
|
4038
|
|
4039 void
|
593
|
4040 gui_mch_flash(int msec)
|
7
|
4041 {
|
|
4042 /* Do a visual beep by reversing the foreground and background colors */
|
|
4043 Rect rc;
|
|
4044
|
|
4045 /*
|
|
4046 * Note: InvertRect() excludes right and bottom of rectangle.
|
|
4047 */
|
|
4048 rc.left = 0;
|
|
4049 rc.top = 0;
|
|
4050 rc.right = gui.num_cols * gui.char_width;
|
|
4051 rc.bottom = gui.num_rows * gui.char_height;
|
|
4052 InvertRect(&rc);
|
|
4053
|
|
4054 ui_delay((long)msec, TRUE); /* wait for some msec */
|
|
4055
|
|
4056 InvertRect(&rc);
|
|
4057 }
|
|
4058
|
|
4059 /*
|
|
4060 * Invert a rectangle from row r, column c, for nr rows and nc columns.
|
|
4061 */
|
|
4062 void
|
593
|
4063 gui_mch_invert_rectangle(int r, int c, int nr, int nc)
|
7
|
4064 {
|
|
4065 Rect rc;
|
|
4066
|
|
4067 /*
|
|
4068 * Note: InvertRect() excludes right and bottom of rectangle.
|
|
4069 */
|
|
4070 rc.left = FILL_X(c);
|
|
4071 rc.top = FILL_Y(r);
|
|
4072 rc.right = rc.left + nc * gui.char_width;
|
|
4073 rc.bottom = rc.top + nr * gui.char_height;
|
|
4074 InvertRect(&rc);
|
|
4075 }
|
|
4076
|
|
4077 /*
|
|
4078 * Iconify the GUI window.
|
|
4079 */
|
|
4080 void
|
593
|
4081 gui_mch_iconify(void)
|
7
|
4082 {
|
|
4083 /* TODO: find out what could replace iconify
|
|
4084 * -window shade?
|
|
4085 * -hide application?
|
|
4086 */
|
|
4087 }
|
|
4088
|
|
4089 #if defined(FEAT_EVAL) || defined(PROTO)
|
|
4090 /*
|
|
4091 * Bring the Vim window to the foreground.
|
|
4092 */
|
|
4093 void
|
593
|
4094 gui_mch_set_foreground(void)
|
7
|
4095 {
|
|
4096 /* TODO */
|
|
4097 }
|
|
4098 #endif
|
|
4099
|
|
4100 /*
|
|
4101 * Draw a cursor without focus.
|
|
4102 */
|
|
4103 void
|
593
|
4104 gui_mch_draw_hollow_cursor(guicolor_T color)
|
7
|
4105 {
|
|
4106 Rect rc;
|
|
4107
|
|
4108 /*
|
|
4109 * Note: FrameRect() excludes right and bottom of rectangle.
|
|
4110 */
|
|
4111 rc.left = FILL_X(gui.col);
|
|
4112 rc.top = FILL_Y(gui.row);
|
|
4113 rc.right = rc.left + gui.char_width;
|
168
|
4114 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
|
|
4115 if (mb_lefthalve(gui.row, gui.col))
|
|
4116 rc.right += gui.char_width;
|
|
4117 #endif
|
7
|
4118 rc.bottom = rc.top + gui.char_height;
|
|
4119
|
|
4120 gui_mch_set_fg_color(color);
|
|
4121
|
9
|
4122 FrameRect(&rc);
|
7
|
4123 }
|
|
4124
|
|
4125 /*
|
|
4126 * Draw part of a cursor, only w pixels wide, and h pixels high.
|
|
4127 */
|
|
4128 void
|
593
|
4129 gui_mch_draw_part_cursor(int w, int h, guicolor_T color)
|
7
|
4130 {
|
|
4131 Rect rc;
|
|
4132
|
|
4133 #ifdef FEAT_RIGHTLEFT
|
|
4134 /* vertical line should be on the right of current point */
|
|
4135 if (CURSOR_BAR_RIGHT)
|
|
4136 rc.left = FILL_X(gui.col + 1) - w;
|
|
4137 else
|
|
4138 #endif
|
|
4139 rc.left = FILL_X(gui.col);
|
|
4140 rc.top = FILL_Y(gui.row) + gui.char_height - h;
|
|
4141 rc.right = rc.left + w;
|
|
4142 rc.bottom = rc.top + h;
|
|
4143
|
|
4144 gui_mch_set_fg_color(color);
|
|
4145
|
168
|
4146 FrameRect(&rc);
|
|
4147 // PaintRect(&rc);
|
7
|
4148 }
|
|
4149
|
|
4150
|
|
4151
|
|
4152 /*
|
|
4153 * Catch up with any queued X events. This may put keyboard input into the
|
|
4154 * input buffer, call resize call-backs, trigger timers etc. If there is
|
|
4155 * nothing in the X event queue (& no timers pending), then we return
|
|
4156 * immediately.
|
|
4157 */
|
|
4158 void
|
593
|
4159 gui_mch_update(void)
|
7
|
4160 {
|
|
4161 /* TODO: find what to do
|
|
4162 * maybe call gui_mch_wait_for_chars (0)
|
|
4163 * more like look at EventQueue then
|
|
4164 * call heart of gui_mch_wait_for_chars;
|
|
4165 *
|
|
4166 * if (eventther)
|
|
4167 * gui_mac_handle_event(&event);
|
|
4168 */
|
|
4169 EventRecord theEvent;
|
|
4170
|
9
|
4171 if (EventAvail(everyEvent, &theEvent))
|
7
|
4172 if (theEvent.what != nullEvent)
|
|
4173 gui_mch_wait_for_chars(0);
|
|
4174 }
|
|
4175
|
|
4176 /*
|
|
4177 * Simple wrapper to neglect more easily the time
|
|
4178 * spent inside WaitNextEvent while profiling.
|
|
4179 */
|
|
4180
|
|
4181 pascal
|
|
4182 Boolean
|
9
|
4183 WaitNextEventWrp(EventMask eventMask, EventRecord *theEvent, UInt32 sleep, RgnHandle mouseRgn)
|
7
|
4184 {
|
|
4185 if (((long) sleep) < -1)
|
|
4186 sleep = 32767;
|
|
4187 return WaitNextEvent(eventMask, theEvent, sleep, mouseRgn);
|
|
4188 }
|
|
4189
|
|
4190 /*
|
|
4191 * GUI input routine called by gui_wait_for_chars(). Waits for a character
|
|
4192 * from the keyboard.
|
|
4193 * wtime == -1 Wait forever.
|
|
4194 * wtime == 0 This should never happen.
|
|
4195 * wtime > 0 Wait wtime milliseconds for a character.
|
|
4196 * Returns OK if a character was found to be available within the given time,
|
|
4197 * or FAIL otherwise.
|
|
4198 */
|
|
4199 int
|
593
|
4200 gui_mch_wait_for_chars(int wtime)
|
7
|
4201 {
|
|
4202 EventMask mask = (everyEvent);
|
|
4203 EventRecord event;
|
|
4204 long entryTick;
|
|
4205 long currentTick;
|
|
4206 long sleeppyTick;
|
|
4207
|
|
4208 /* If we are providing life feedback with the scrollbar,
|
|
4209 * we don't want to try to wait for an event, or else
|
|
4210 * there won't be any life feedback.
|
|
4211 */
|
|
4212 if (dragged_sb != NULL)
|
|
4213 return FAIL;
|
|
4214 /* TODO: Check if FAIL is the proper return code */
|
|
4215
|
|
4216 entryTick = TickCount();
|
|
4217
|
|
4218 allow_scrollbar = TRUE;
|
|
4219
|
|
4220 do
|
|
4221 {
|
|
4222 /* if (dragRectControl == kCreateEmpty)
|
|
4223 {
|
|
4224 dragRgn = NULL;
|
|
4225 dragRectControl = kNothing;
|
|
4226 }
|
|
4227 else*/ if (dragRectControl == kCreateRect)
|
|
4228 {
|
|
4229 dragRgn = cursorRgn;
|
9
|
4230 RectRgn(dragRgn, &dragRect);
|
7
|
4231 dragRectControl = kNothing;
|
|
4232 }
|
|
4233 /*
|
|
4234 * Don't use gui_mch_update() because then we will spin-lock until a
|
|
4235 * char arrives, instead we use WaitNextEventWrp() to hang until an
|
|
4236 * event arrives. No need to check for input_buf_full because we are
|
|
4237 * returning as soon as it contains a single char.
|
|
4238 */
|
|
4239 /* TODO: reduce wtime accordinly??? */
|
|
4240 if (wtime > -1)
|
|
4241 sleeppyTick = 60*wtime/1000;
|
|
4242 else
|
|
4243 sleeppyTick = 32767;
|
9
|
4244 if (WaitNextEventWrp(mask, &event, sleeppyTick, dragRgn))
|
7
|
4245 {
|
9
|
4246 gui_mac_handle_event(&event);
|
7
|
4247 if (input_available())
|
|
4248 {
|
|
4249 allow_scrollbar = FALSE;
|
|
4250 return OK;
|
|
4251 }
|
|
4252 }
|
|
4253 currentTick = TickCount();
|
|
4254 }
|
|
4255 while ((wtime == -1) || ((currentTick - entryTick) < 60*wtime/1000));
|
|
4256
|
|
4257 allow_scrollbar = FALSE;
|
|
4258 return FAIL;
|
|
4259 }
|
|
4260
|
|
4261 /*
|
|
4262 * Output routines.
|
|
4263 */
|
|
4264
|
|
4265 /* Flush any output to the screen */
|
|
4266 void
|
593
|
4267 gui_mch_flush(void)
|
7
|
4268 {
|
|
4269 /* TODO: Is anything needed here? */
|
|
4270 }
|
|
4271
|
|
4272 /*
|
|
4273 * Clear a rectangular region of the screen from text pos (row1, col1) to
|
|
4274 * (row2, col2) inclusive.
|
|
4275 */
|
|
4276 void
|
593
|
4277 gui_mch_clear_block(int row1, int col1, int row2, int col2)
|
7
|
4278 {
|
|
4279 Rect rc;
|
|
4280
|
|
4281 /*
|
|
4282 * Clear one extra pixel at the far right, for when bold characters have
|
|
4283 * spilled over to the next column.
|
|
4284 */
|
|
4285 rc.left = FILL_X(col1);
|
|
4286 rc.top = FILL_Y(row1);
|
|
4287 rc.right = FILL_X(col2 + 1) + (col2 == Columns - 1);
|
|
4288 rc.bottom = FILL_Y(row2 + 1);
|
|
4289
|
|
4290 gui_mch_set_bg_color(gui.back_pixel);
|
9
|
4291 EraseRect(&rc);
|
7
|
4292 }
|
|
4293
|
|
4294 /*
|
|
4295 * Clear the whole text window.
|
|
4296 */
|
|
4297 void
|
593
|
4298 gui_mch_clear_all(void)
|
7
|
4299 {
|
|
4300 Rect rc;
|
|
4301
|
|
4302 rc.left = 0;
|
|
4303 rc.top = 0;
|
|
4304 rc.right = Columns * gui.char_width + 2 * gui.border_width;
|
|
4305 rc.bottom = Rows * gui.char_height + 2 * gui.border_width;
|
|
4306
|
|
4307 gui_mch_set_bg_color(gui.back_pixel);
|
|
4308 EraseRect(&rc);
|
|
4309 /* gui_mch_set_fg_color(gui.norm_pixel);
|
|
4310 FrameRect(&rc);
|
|
4311 */
|
|
4312 }
|
|
4313
|
|
4314 /*
|
|
4315 * Delete the given number of lines from the given row, scrolling up any
|
|
4316 * text further down within the scroll region.
|
|
4317 */
|
|
4318 void
|
593
|
4319 gui_mch_delete_lines(int row, int num_lines)
|
7
|
4320 {
|
|
4321 Rect rc;
|
|
4322
|
|
4323 /* changed without checking! */
|
|
4324 rc.left = FILL_X(gui.scroll_region_left);
|
|
4325 rc.right = FILL_X(gui.scroll_region_right + 1);
|
|
4326 rc.top = FILL_Y(row);
|
|
4327 rc.bottom = FILL_Y(gui.scroll_region_bot + 1);
|
|
4328
|
|
4329 gui_mch_set_bg_color(gui.back_pixel);
|
9
|
4330 ScrollRect(&rc, 0, -num_lines * gui.char_height, (RgnHandle) nil);
|
7
|
4331
|
|
4332 gui_clear_block(gui.scroll_region_bot - num_lines + 1,
|
|
4333 gui.scroll_region_left,
|
|
4334 gui.scroll_region_bot, gui.scroll_region_right);
|
|
4335 }
|
|
4336
|
|
4337 /*
|
|
4338 * Insert the given number of lines before the given row, scrolling down any
|
|
4339 * following text within the scroll region.
|
|
4340 */
|
|
4341 void
|
593
|
4342 gui_mch_insert_lines(int row, int num_lines)
|
7
|
4343 {
|
|
4344 Rect rc;
|
|
4345
|
|
4346 rc.left = FILL_X(gui.scroll_region_left);
|
|
4347 rc.right = FILL_X(gui.scroll_region_right + 1);
|
|
4348 rc.top = FILL_Y(row);
|
|
4349 rc.bottom = FILL_Y(gui.scroll_region_bot + 1);
|
|
4350
|
|
4351 gui_mch_set_bg_color(gui.back_pixel);
|
|
4352
|
9
|
4353 ScrollRect(&rc, 0, gui.char_height * num_lines, (RgnHandle) nil);
|
7
|
4354
|
|
4355 /* Update gui.cursor_row if the cursor scrolled or copied over */
|
|
4356 if (gui.cursor_row >= gui.row
|
|
4357 && gui.cursor_col >= gui.scroll_region_left
|
|
4358 && gui.cursor_col <= gui.scroll_region_right)
|
|
4359 {
|
|
4360 if (gui.cursor_row <= gui.scroll_region_bot - num_lines)
|
|
4361 gui.cursor_row += num_lines;
|
|
4362 else if (gui.cursor_row <= gui.scroll_region_bot)
|
|
4363 gui.cursor_is_valid = FALSE;
|
|
4364 }
|
|
4365
|
|
4366 gui_clear_block(row, gui.scroll_region_left,
|
|
4367 row + num_lines - 1, gui.scroll_region_right);
|
|
4368 }
|
|
4369
|
|
4370 /*
|
|
4371 * TODO: add a vim format to the clipboard which remember
|
|
4372 * LINEWISE, CHARWISE, BLOCKWISE
|
|
4373 */
|
|
4374
|
|
4375 void
|
593
|
4376 clip_mch_request_selection(VimClipboard *cbd)
|
7
|
4377 {
|
|
4378
|
|
4379 Handle textOfClip;
|
19
|
4380 int flavor = 0;
|
7
|
4381 Size scrapSize;
|
|
4382 ScrapFlavorFlags scrapFlags;
|
|
4383 ScrapRef scrap = nil;
|
|
4384 OSStatus error;
|
|
4385 int type;
|
|
4386 char *searchCR;
|
|
4387 char_u *tempclip;
|
|
4388
|
|
4389
|
9
|
4390 error = GetCurrentScrap(&scrap);
|
7
|
4391 if (error != noErr)
|
|
4392 return;
|
|
4393
|
9
|
4394 error = GetScrapFlavorFlags(scrap, VIMSCRAPFLAVOR, &scrapFlags);
|
|
4395 if (error == noErr)
|
|
4396 {
|
|
4397 error = GetScrapFlavorSize(scrap, VIMSCRAPFLAVOR, &scrapSize);
|
|
4398 if (error == noErr && scrapSize > 1)
|
|
4399 flavor = 1;
|
|
4400 }
|
|
4401
|
|
4402 if (flavor == 0)
|
|
4403 {
|
838
|
4404 error = GetScrapFlavorFlags(scrap, SCRAPTEXTFLAVOR, &scrapFlags);
|
9
|
4405 if (error != noErr)
|
|
4406 return;
|
|
4407
|
838
|
4408 error = GetScrapFlavorSize(scrap, SCRAPTEXTFLAVOR, &scrapSize);
|
9
|
4409 if (error != noErr)
|
|
4410 return;
|
|
4411 }
|
|
4412
|
|
4413 ReserveMem(scrapSize);
|
593
|
4414
|
838
|
4415 /* In CARBON we don't need a Handle, a pointer is good */
|
|
4416 textOfClip = NewHandle(scrapSize);
|
|
4417
|
|
4418 /* tempclip = lalloc(scrapSize+1, TRUE); */
|
|
4419 HLock(textOfClip);
|
|
4420 error = GetScrapFlavorData(scrap,
|
|
4421 flavor ? VIMSCRAPFLAVOR : SCRAPTEXTFLAVOR,
|
|
4422 &scrapSize, *textOfClip);
|
|
4423 scrapSize -= flavor;
|
|
4424
|
|
4425 if (flavor)
|
|
4426 type = **textOfClip;
|
|
4427 else
|
|
4428 type = (strchr(*textOfClip, '\r') != NULL) ? MLINE : MCHAR;
|
|
4429
|
|
4430 tempclip = lalloc(scrapSize + 1, TRUE);
|
|
4431 mch_memmove(tempclip, *textOfClip + flavor, scrapSize);
|
|
4432 tempclip[scrapSize] = 0;
|
7
|
4433
|
766
|
4434 #ifdef MACOS_CONVERT
|
838
|
4435 {
|
168
|
4436 /* Convert from utf-16 (clipboard) */
|
|
4437 size_t encLen = 0;
|
|
4438 char_u *to = mac_utf16_to_enc((UniChar *)tempclip, scrapSize, &encLen);
|
838
|
4439
|
|
4440 if (to != NULL)
|
7
|
4441 {
|
168
|
4442 scrapSize = encLen;
|
|
4443 vim_free(tempclip);
|
|
4444 tempclip = to;
|
7
|
4445 }
|
838
|
4446 }
|
7
|
4447 #endif
|
502
|
4448
|
838
|
4449 searchCR = (char *)tempclip;
|
|
4450 while (searchCR != NULL)
|
|
4451 {
|
|
4452 searchCR = strchr(searchCR, '\r');
|
|
4453 if (searchCR != NULL)
|
|
4454 *searchCR = '\n';
|
7
|
4455 }
|
838
|
4456
|
|
4457 clip_yank_selection(type, tempclip, scrapSize, cbd);
|
|
4458
|
|
4459 vim_free(tempclip);
|
|
4460 HUnlock(textOfClip);
|
|
4461
|
|
4462 DisposeHandle(textOfClip);
|
7
|
4463 }
|
|
4464
|
|
4465 void
|
593
|
4466 clip_mch_lose_selection(VimClipboard *cbd)
|
7
|
4467 {
|
|
4468 /*
|
|
4469 * TODO: Really nothing to do?
|
|
4470 */
|
|
4471 }
|
|
4472
|
|
4473 int
|
593
|
4474 clip_mch_own_selection(VimClipboard *cbd)
|
7
|
4475 {
|
|
4476 return OK;
|
|
4477 }
|
|
4478
|
|
4479 /*
|
|
4480 * Send the current selection to the clipboard.
|
|
4481 */
|
|
4482 void
|
593
|
4483 clip_mch_set_selection(VimClipboard *cbd)
|
7
|
4484 {
|
|
4485 Handle textOfClip;
|
|
4486 long scrapSize;
|
|
4487 int type;
|
|
4488 ScrapRef scrap;
|
|
4489
|
|
4490 char_u *str = NULL;
|
|
4491
|
|
4492 if (!cbd->owned)
|
|
4493 return;
|
|
4494
|
|
4495 clip_get_selection(cbd);
|
|
4496
|
|
4497 /*
|
|
4498 * Once we set the clipboard, lose ownership. If another application sets
|
|
4499 * the clipboard, we don't want to think that we still own it.
|
|
4500 */
|
|
4501 cbd->owned = FALSE;
|
|
4502
|
838
|
4503 type = clip_convert_selection(&str, (long_u *)&scrapSize, cbd);
|
7
|
4504
|
766
|
4505 #ifdef MACOS_CONVERT
|
168
|
4506 size_t utf16_len = 0;
|
|
4507 UniChar *to = mac_enc_to_utf16(str, scrapSize, &utf16_len);
|
|
4508 if (to)
|
7
|
4509 {
|
168
|
4510 scrapSize = utf16_len;
|
|
4511 vim_free(str);
|
|
4512 str = (char_u *)to;
|
7
|
4513 }
|
|
4514 #endif
|
|
4515
|
|
4516 if (type >= 0)
|
|
4517 {
|
|
4518 ClearCurrentScrap();
|
593
|
4519
|
9
|
4520 textOfClip = NewHandle(scrapSize + 1);
|
7
|
4521 HLock(textOfClip);
|
|
4522
|
9
|
4523 **textOfClip = type;
|
168
|
4524 mch_memmove(*textOfClip + 1, str, scrapSize);
|
9
|
4525 GetCurrentScrap(&scrap);
|
838
|
4526 PutScrapFlavor(scrap, SCRAPTEXTFLAVOR, kScrapFlavorMaskNone,
|
9
|
4527 scrapSize, *textOfClip + 1);
|
|
4528 PutScrapFlavor(scrap, VIMSCRAPFLAVOR, kScrapFlavorMaskNone,
|
|
4529 scrapSize + 1, *textOfClip);
|
7
|
4530 HUnlock(textOfClip);
|
|
4531 DisposeHandle(textOfClip);
|
|
4532 }
|
|
4533
|
|
4534 vim_free(str);
|
|
4535 }
|
|
4536
|
|
4537 void
|
593
|
4538 gui_mch_set_text_area_pos(int x, int y, int w, int h)
|
7
|
4539 {
|
|
4540 Rect VimBound;
|
|
4541
|
9
|
4542 /* HideWindow(gui.VimWindow); */
|
7
|
4543 GetWindowBounds(gui.VimWindow, kWindowGlobalPortRgn, &VimBound);
|
|
4544
|
|
4545 if (gui.which_scrollbars[SBAR_LEFT])
|
|
4546 {
|
|
4547 VimBound.left = -gui.scrollbar_width + 1;
|
|
4548 }
|
|
4549 else
|
|
4550 {
|
|
4551 VimBound.left = 0;
|
|
4552 }
|
|
4553
|
|
4554 SetWindowBounds(gui.VimWindow, kWindowGlobalPortRgn, &VimBound);
|
|
4555
|
9
|
4556 ShowWindow(gui.VimWindow);
|
7
|
4557 }
|
|
4558
|
|
4559 /*
|
|
4560 * Menu stuff.
|
|
4561 */
|
|
4562
|
|
4563 void
|
593
|
4564 gui_mch_enable_menu(int flag)
|
7
|
4565 {
|
|
4566 /*
|
444
|
4567 * Menu is always active.
|
7
|
4568 */
|
|
4569 }
|
|
4570
|
|
4571 void
|
593
|
4572 gui_mch_set_menu_pos(int x, int y, int w, int h)
|
7
|
4573 {
|
|
4574 /*
|
444
|
4575 * The menu is always at the top of the screen.
|
7
|
4576 */
|
|
4577 }
|
|
4578
|
|
4579 /*
|
|
4580 * Add a sub menu to the menu bar.
|
|
4581 */
|
|
4582 void
|
593
|
4583 gui_mch_add_menu(vimmenu_T *menu, int idx)
|
7
|
4584 {
|
|
4585 /*
|
|
4586 * TODO: Try to use only menu_id instead of both menu_id and menu_handle.
|
|
4587 * TODO: use menu->mnemonic and menu->actext
|
|
4588 * TODO: Try to reuse menu id
|
|
4589 * Carbon Help suggest to use only id between 1 and 235
|
|
4590 */
|
|
4591 static long next_avail_id = 128;
|
|
4592 long menu_after_me = 0; /* Default to the end */
|
593
|
4593 #if defined(FEAT_MBYTE)
|
168
|
4594 CFStringRef name;
|
|
4595 #else
|
7
|
4596 char_u *name;
|
168
|
4597 #endif
|
7
|
4598 short index;
|
|
4599 vimmenu_T *parent = menu->parent;
|
|
4600 vimmenu_T *brother = menu->next;
|
|
4601
|
|
4602 /* Cannot add a menu if ... */
|
|
4603 if ((parent != NULL && parent->submenu_id == 0))
|
|
4604 return;
|
|
4605
|
|
4606 /* menu ID greater than 1024 are reserved for ??? */
|
|
4607 if (next_avail_id == 1024)
|
|
4608 return;
|
|
4609
|
|
4610 /* My brother could be the PopUp, find my real brother */
|
|
4611 while ((brother != NULL) && (!menu_is_menubar(brother->name)))
|
|
4612 brother = brother->next;
|
|
4613
|
|
4614 /* Find where to insert the menu (for MenuBar) */
|
|
4615 if ((parent == NULL) && (brother != NULL))
|
|
4616 menu_after_me = brother->submenu_id;
|
|
4617
|
|
4618 /* If the menu is not part of the menubar (and its submenus), add it 'nowhere' */
|
|
4619 if (!menu_is_menubar(menu->name))
|
|
4620 menu_after_me = hierMenu;
|
|
4621
|
|
4622 /* Convert the name */
|
766
|
4623 #ifdef MACOS_CONVERT
|
168
|
4624 name = menu_title_removing_mnemonic(menu);
|
|
4625 #else
|
7
|
4626 name = C2Pascal_save(menu->dname);
|
168
|
4627 #endif
|
7
|
4628 if (name == NULL)
|
|
4629 return;
|
|
4630
|
|
4631 /* Create the menu unless it's the help menu */
|
|
4632 {
|
|
4633 /* Carbon suggest use of
|
9
|
4634 * OSStatus CreateNewMenu(MenuID, MenuAttributes, MenuRef *);
|
|
4635 * OSStatus SetMenuTitle(MenuRef, ConstStr255Param title);
|
7
|
4636 */
|
|
4637 menu->submenu_id = next_avail_id;
|
593
|
4638 #if defined(FEAT_MBYTE)
|
168
|
4639 if (CreateNewMenu(menu->submenu_id, 0, (MenuRef *)&menu->submenu_handle) == noErr)
|
|
4640 SetMenuTitleWithCFString((MenuRef)menu->submenu_handle, name);
|
|
4641 #else
|
9
|
4642 menu->submenu_handle = NewMenu(menu->submenu_id, name);
|
168
|
4643 #endif
|
7
|
4644 next_avail_id++;
|
|
4645 }
|
|
4646
|
|
4647 if (parent == NULL)
|
|
4648 {
|
|
4649 /* Adding a menu to the menubar, or in the no mans land (for PopUp) */
|
|
4650
|
|
4651 /* TODO: Verify if we could only Insert Menu if really part of the
|
|
4652 * menubar The Inserted menu are scanned or the Command-key combos
|
|
4653 */
|
|
4654
|
593
|
4655 /* Insert the menu */
|
|
4656 InsertMenu(menu->submenu_handle, menu_after_me); /* insert before */
|
7
|
4657 #if 1
|
|
4658 /* Vim should normally update it. TODO: verify */
|
|
4659 DrawMenuBar();
|
|
4660 #endif
|
|
4661 }
|
|
4662 else
|
|
4663 {
|
|
4664 /* Adding as a submenu */
|
|
4665
|
9
|
4666 index = gui_mac_get_menu_item_index(menu);
|
7
|
4667
|
|
4668 /* Call InsertMenuItem followed by SetMenuItemText
|
|
4669 * to avoid special character recognition by InsertMenuItem
|
|
4670 */
|
|
4671 InsertMenuItem(parent->submenu_handle, "\p ", idx); /* afterItem */
|
593
|
4672 #if defined(FEAT_MBYTE)
|
168
|
4673 SetMenuItemTextWithCFString(parent->submenu_handle, idx+1, name);
|
|
4674 #else
|
7
|
4675 SetMenuItemText(parent->submenu_handle, idx+1, name);
|
168
|
4676 #endif
|
7
|
4677 SetItemCmd(parent->submenu_handle, idx+1, 0x1B);
|
|
4678 SetItemMark(parent->submenu_handle, idx+1, menu->submenu_id);
|
|
4679 InsertMenu(menu->submenu_handle, hierMenu);
|
|
4680 }
|
|
4681
|
593
|
4682 #if defined(FEAT_MBYTE)
|
168
|
4683 CFRelease(name);
|
|
4684 #else
|
9
|
4685 vim_free(name);
|
168
|
4686 #endif
|
7
|
4687
|
|
4688 #if 0
|
|
4689 /* Done by Vim later on */
|
|
4690 DrawMenuBar();
|
|
4691 #endif
|
|
4692 }
|
|
4693
|
|
4694 /*
|
|
4695 * Add a menu item to a menu
|
|
4696 */
|
|
4697 void
|
593
|
4698 gui_mch_add_menu_item(vimmenu_T *menu, int idx)
|
7
|
4699 {
|
593
|
4700 #if defined(FEAT_MBYTE)
|
168
|
4701 CFStringRef name;
|
|
4702 #else
|
7
|
4703 char_u *name;
|
168
|
4704 #endif
|
7
|
4705 vimmenu_T *parent = menu->parent;
|
|
4706 int menu_inserted;
|
|
4707
|
|
4708 /* Cannot add item, if the menu have not been created */
|
|
4709 if (parent->submenu_id == 0)
|
|
4710 return;
|
|
4711
|
|
4712 /* Could call SetMenuRefCon [CARBON] to associate with the Menu,
|
|
4713 for older OS call GetMenuItemData (menu, item, isCommandID?, data) */
|
|
4714
|
|
4715 /* Convert the name */
|
766
|
4716 #ifdef MACOS_CONVERT
|
168
|
4717 name = menu_title_removing_mnemonic(menu);
|
|
4718 #else
|
7
|
4719 name = C2Pascal_save(menu->dname);
|
168
|
4720 #endif
|
7
|
4721
|
|
4722 /* Where are just a menu item, so no handle, no id */
|
|
4723 menu->submenu_id = 0;
|
|
4724 menu->submenu_handle = NULL;
|
|
4725
|
|
4726 menu_inserted = 0;
|
|
4727 if (menu->actext)
|
|
4728 {
|
|
4729 /* If the accelerator text for the menu item looks like it describes
|
|
4730 * a command key (e.g., "<D-S-t>" or "<C-7>"), display it as the
|
|
4731 * item's command equivalent.
|
|
4732 */
|
|
4733 int key = 0;
|
|
4734 int modifiers = 0;
|
|
4735 char_u *p_actext;
|
|
4736
|
|
4737 p_actext = menu->actext;
|
|
4738 key = find_special_key(&p_actext, &modifiers, /*keycode=*/0);
|
|
4739 if (*p_actext != 0)
|
|
4740 key = 0; /* error: trailing text */
|
|
4741 /* find_special_key() returns a keycode with as many of the
|
|
4742 * specified modifiers as appropriate already applied (e.g., for
|
|
4743 * "<D-C-x>" it returns Ctrl-X as the keycode and MOD_MASK_CMD
|
|
4744 * as the only modifier). Since we want to display all of the
|
|
4745 * modifiers, we need to convert the keycode back to a printable
|
|
4746 * character plus modifiers.
|
|
4747 * TODO: Write an alternative find_special_key() that doesn't
|
|
4748 * apply modifiers.
|
|
4749 */
|
|
4750 if (key > 0 && key < 32)
|
|
4751 {
|
|
4752 /* Convert a control key to an uppercase letter. Note that
|
|
4753 * by this point it is no longer possible to distinguish
|
|
4754 * between, e.g., Ctrl-S and Ctrl-Shift-S.
|
|
4755 */
|
|
4756 modifiers |= MOD_MASK_CTRL;
|
|
4757 key += '@';
|
|
4758 }
|
|
4759 /* If the keycode is an uppercase letter, set the Shift modifier.
|
|
4760 * If it is a lowercase letter, don't set the modifier, but convert
|
|
4761 * the letter to uppercase for display in the menu.
|
|
4762 */
|
|
4763 else if (key >= 'A' && key <= 'Z')
|
|
4764 modifiers |= MOD_MASK_SHIFT;
|
|
4765 else if (key >= 'a' && key <= 'z')
|
|
4766 key += 'A' - 'a';
|
|
4767 /* Note: keycodes below 0x22 are reserved by Apple. */
|
|
4768 if (key >= 0x22 && vim_isprintc_strict(key))
|
|
4769 {
|
|
4770 int valid = 1;
|
|
4771 char_u mac_mods = kMenuNoModifiers;
|
|
4772 /* Convert Vim modifier codes to Menu Manager equivalents. */
|
|
4773 if (modifiers & MOD_MASK_SHIFT)
|
|
4774 mac_mods |= kMenuShiftModifier;
|
|
4775 if (modifiers & MOD_MASK_CTRL)
|
|
4776 mac_mods |= kMenuControlModifier;
|
|
4777 if (!(modifiers & MOD_MASK_CMD))
|
|
4778 mac_mods |= kMenuNoCommandModifier;
|
|
4779 if (modifiers & MOD_MASK_ALT || modifiers & MOD_MASK_MULTI_CLICK)
|
|
4780 valid = 0; /* TODO: will Alt someday map to Option? */
|
|
4781 if (valid)
|
|
4782 {
|
|
4783 char_u item_txt[10];
|
|
4784 /* Insert the menu item after idx, with its command key. */
|
|
4785 item_txt[0] = 3; item_txt[1] = ' '; item_txt[2] = '/';
|
|
4786 item_txt[3] = key;
|
|
4787 InsertMenuItem(parent->submenu_handle, item_txt, idx);
|
|
4788 /* Set the modifier keys. */
|
|
4789 SetMenuItemModifiers(parent->submenu_handle, idx+1, mac_mods);
|
|
4790 menu_inserted = 1;
|
|
4791 }
|
|
4792 }
|
|
4793 }
|
|
4794 /* Call InsertMenuItem followed by SetMenuItemText
|
|
4795 * to avoid special character recognition by InsertMenuItem
|
|
4796 */
|
|
4797 if (!menu_inserted)
|
|
4798 InsertMenuItem(parent->submenu_handle, "\p ", idx); /* afterItem */
|
|
4799 /* Set the menu item name. */
|
593
|
4800 #if defined(FEAT_MBYTE)
|
168
|
4801 SetMenuItemTextWithCFString(parent->submenu_handle, idx+1, name);
|
|
4802 #else
|
7
|
4803 SetMenuItemText(parent->submenu_handle, idx+1, name);
|
168
|
4804 #endif
|
7
|
4805
|
|
4806 #if 0
|
|
4807 /* Called by Vim */
|
|
4808 DrawMenuBar();
|
|
4809 #endif
|
|
4810
|
593
|
4811 #if defined(FEAT_MBYTE)
|
168
|
4812 CFRelease(name);
|
|
4813 #else
|
7
|
4814 /* TODO: Can name be freed? */
|
|
4815 vim_free(name);
|
168
|
4816 #endif
|
7
|
4817 }
|
|
4818
|
|
4819 void
|
593
|
4820 gui_mch_toggle_tearoffs(int enable)
|
7
|
4821 {
|
|
4822 /* no tearoff menus */
|
|
4823 }
|
|
4824
|
|
4825 /*
|
|
4826 * Destroy the machine specific menu widget.
|
|
4827 */
|
|
4828 void
|
593
|
4829 gui_mch_destroy_menu(vimmenu_T *menu)
|
7
|
4830 {
|
9
|
4831 short index = gui_mac_get_menu_item_index(menu);
|
7
|
4832
|
|
4833 if (index > 0)
|
|
4834 {
|
|
4835 if (menu->parent)
|
|
4836 {
|
|
4837 {
|
|
4838 /* For now just don't delete help menu items. (Huh? Dany) */
|
9
|
4839 DeleteMenuItem(menu->parent->submenu_handle, index);
|
7
|
4840
|
|
4841 /* Delete the Menu if it was a hierarchical Menu */
|
|
4842 if (menu->submenu_id != 0)
|
|
4843 {
|
9
|
4844 DeleteMenu(menu->submenu_id);
|
|
4845 DisposeMenu(menu->submenu_handle);
|
7
|
4846 }
|
|
4847 }
|
|
4848 }
|
|
4849 #ifdef DEBUG_MAC_MENU
|
|
4850 else
|
|
4851 {
|
9
|
4852 printf("gmdm 2\n");
|
7
|
4853 }
|
|
4854 #endif
|
|
4855 }
|
|
4856 else
|
|
4857 {
|
|
4858 {
|
9
|
4859 DeleteMenu(menu->submenu_id);
|
|
4860 DisposeMenu(menu->submenu_handle);
|
7
|
4861 }
|
|
4862 }
|
|
4863 /* Shouldn't this be already done by Vim. TODO: Check */
|
|
4864 DrawMenuBar();
|
|
4865 }
|
|
4866
|
|
4867 /*
|
|
4868 * Make a menu either grey or not grey.
|
|
4869 */
|
|
4870 void
|
593
|
4871 gui_mch_menu_grey(vimmenu_T *menu, int grey)
|
7
|
4872 {
|
|
4873 /* TODO: Check if menu really exists */
|
9
|
4874 short index = gui_mac_get_menu_item_index(menu);
|
7
|
4875 /*
|
|
4876 index = menu->index;
|
|
4877 */
|
|
4878 if (grey)
|
|
4879 {
|
|
4880 if (menu->children)
|
|
4881 DisableMenuItem(menu->submenu_handle, index);
|
|
4882 if (menu->parent)
|
|
4883 if (menu->parent->submenu_handle)
|
|
4884 DisableMenuItem(menu->parent->submenu_handle, index);
|
|
4885 }
|
|
4886 else
|
|
4887 {
|
|
4888 if (menu->children)
|
|
4889 EnableMenuItem(menu->submenu_handle, index);
|
|
4890 if (menu->parent)
|
|
4891 if (menu->parent->submenu_handle)
|
|
4892 EnableMenuItem(menu->parent->submenu_handle, index);
|
|
4893 }
|
|
4894 }
|
|
4895
|
|
4896 /*
|
|
4897 * Make menu item hidden or not hidden
|
|
4898 */
|
|
4899 void
|
593
|
4900 gui_mch_menu_hidden(vimmenu_T *menu, int hidden)
|
7
|
4901 {
|
|
4902 /* There's no hidden mode on MacOS */
|
9
|
4903 gui_mch_menu_grey(menu, hidden);
|
7
|
4904 }
|
|
4905
|
|
4906
|
|
4907 /*
|
|
4908 * This is called after setting all the menus to grey/hidden or not.
|
|
4909 */
|
|
4910 void
|
593
|
4911 gui_mch_draw_menubar(void)
|
7
|
4912 {
|
|
4913 DrawMenuBar();
|
|
4914 }
|
|
4915
|
|
4916
|
|
4917 /*
|
|
4918 * Scrollbar stuff.
|
|
4919 */
|
|
4920
|
|
4921 void
|
593
|
4922 gui_mch_enable_scrollbar(
|
|
4923 scrollbar_T *sb,
|
|
4924 int flag)
|
7
|
4925 {
|
|
4926 if (flag)
|
|
4927 ShowControl(sb->id);
|
|
4928 else
|
|
4929 HideControl(sb->id);
|
|
4930
|
|
4931 #ifdef DEBUG_MAC_SB
|
9
|
4932 printf("enb_sb (%x) %x\n",sb->id, flag);
|
7
|
4933 #endif
|
|
4934 }
|
|
4935
|
|
4936 void
|
593
|
4937 gui_mch_set_scrollbar_thumb(
|
|
4938 scrollbar_T *sb,
|
|
4939 long val,
|
|
4940 long size,
|
|
4941 long max)
|
7
|
4942 {
|
|
4943 SetControl32BitMaximum (sb->id, max);
|
|
4944 SetControl32BitMinimum (sb->id, 0);
|
|
4945 SetControl32BitValue (sb->id, val);
|
1107
|
4946 SetControlViewSize (sb->id, size);
|
7
|
4947 #ifdef DEBUG_MAC_SB
|
9
|
4948 printf("thumb_sb (%x) %x, %x,%x\n",sb->id, val, size, max);
|
7
|
4949 #endif
|
|
4950 }
|
|
4951
|
|
4952 void
|
593
|
4953 gui_mch_set_scrollbar_pos(
|
|
4954 scrollbar_T *sb,
|
|
4955 int x,
|
|
4956 int y,
|
|
4957 int w,
|
|
4958 int h)
|
7
|
4959 {
|
|
4960 gui_mch_set_bg_color(gui.back_pixel);
|
|
4961 /* if (gui.which_scrollbars[SBAR_LEFT])
|
|
4962 {
|
9
|
4963 MoveControl(sb->id, x-16, y);
|
|
4964 SizeControl(sb->id, w + 1, h);
|
7
|
4965 }
|
|
4966 else
|
|
4967 {
|
9
|
4968 MoveControl(sb->id, x, y);
|
|
4969 SizeControl(sb->id, w + 1, h);
|
7
|
4970 }*/
|
|
4971 if (sb == &gui.bottom_sbar)
|
|
4972 h += 1;
|
|
4973 else
|
|
4974 w += 1;
|
|
4975
|
|
4976 if (gui.which_scrollbars[SBAR_LEFT])
|
|
4977 x -= 15;
|
|
4978
|
9
|
4979 MoveControl(sb->id, x, y);
|
|
4980 SizeControl(sb->id, w, h);
|
7
|
4981 #ifdef DEBUG_MAC_SB
|
9
|
4982 printf("size_sb (%x) %x, %x, %x, %x\n",sb->id, x, y, w, h);
|
7
|
4983 #endif
|
|
4984 }
|
|
4985
|
|
4986 void
|
593
|
4987 gui_mch_create_scrollbar(
|
|
4988 scrollbar_T *sb,
|
|
4989 int orient) /* SBAR_VERT or SBAR_HORIZ */
|
7
|
4990 {
|
|
4991 Rect bounds;
|
|
4992
|
|
4993 bounds.top = -16;
|
|
4994 bounds.bottom = -10;
|
|
4995 bounds.right = -10;
|
|
4996 bounds.left = -16;
|
|
4997
|
9
|
4998 sb->id = NewControl(gui.VimWindow,
|
7
|
4999 &bounds,
|
|
5000 "\pScrollBar",
|
|
5001 TRUE,
|
|
5002 0, /* current*/
|
|
5003 0, /* top */
|
|
5004 0, /* bottom */
|
|
5005 kControlScrollBarLiveProc,
|
|
5006 (long) sb->ident);
|
|
5007 #ifdef DEBUG_MAC_SB
|
9
|
5008 printf("create_sb (%x) %x\n",sb->id, orient);
|
7
|
5009 #endif
|
|
5010 }
|
|
5011
|
|
5012 void
|
593
|
5013 gui_mch_destroy_scrollbar(scrollbar_T *sb)
|
7
|
5014 {
|
|
5015 gui_mch_set_bg_color(gui.back_pixel);
|
9
|
5016 DisposeControl(sb->id);
|
7
|
5017 #ifdef DEBUG_MAC_SB
|
9
|
5018 printf("dest_sb (%x) \n",sb->id);
|
7
|
5019 #endif
|
|
5020 }
|
|
5021
|
|
5022
|
|
5023 /*
|
|
5024 * Cursor blink functions.
|
|
5025 *
|
|
5026 * This is a simple state machine:
|
|
5027 * BLINK_NONE not blinking at all
|
|
5028 * BLINK_OFF blinking, cursor is not shown
|
|
5029 * BLINK_ON blinking, cursor is shown
|
|
5030 */
|
|
5031 void
|
|
5032 gui_mch_set_blinking(long wait, long on, long off)
|
|
5033 {
|
|
5034 /* TODO: TODO: TODO: TODO: */
|
|
5035 /* blink_waittime = wait;
|
|
5036 blink_ontime = on;
|
|
5037 blink_offtime = off;*/
|
|
5038 }
|
|
5039
|
|
5040 /*
|
|
5041 * Stop the cursor blinking. Show the cursor if it wasn't shown.
|
|
5042 */
|
|
5043 void
|
593
|
5044 gui_mch_stop_blink(void)
|
7
|
5045 {
|
|
5046 gui_update_cursor(TRUE, FALSE);
|
|
5047 /* TODO: TODO: TODO: TODO: */
|
|
5048 /* gui_w32_rm_blink_timer();
|
|
5049 if (blink_state == BLINK_OFF)
|
|
5050 gui_update_cursor(TRUE, FALSE);
|
|
5051 blink_state = BLINK_NONE;*/
|
|
5052 }
|
|
5053
|
|
5054 /*
|
|
5055 * Start the cursor blinking. If it was already blinking, this restarts the
|
|
5056 * waiting time and shows the cursor.
|
|
5057 */
|
|
5058 void
|
593
|
5059 gui_mch_start_blink(void)
|
7
|
5060 {
|
|
5061 gui_update_cursor(TRUE, FALSE);
|
|
5062 /* TODO: TODO: TODO: TODO: */
|
|
5063 /* gui_w32_rm_blink_timer(); */
|
|
5064
|
|
5065 /* Only switch blinking on if none of the times is zero */
|
|
5066 /* if (blink_waittime && blink_ontime && blink_offtime)
|
|
5067 {
|
|
5068 blink_timer = SetTimer(NULL, 0, (UINT)blink_waittime,
|
|
5069 (TIMERPROC)_OnBlinkTimer);
|
|
5070 blink_state = BLINK_ON;
|
|
5071 gui_update_cursor(TRUE, FALSE);
|
|
5072 }*/
|
|
5073 }
|
|
5074
|
|
5075 /*
|
|
5076 * Return the RGB value of a pixel as long.
|
|
5077 */
|
|
5078 long_u
|
|
5079 gui_mch_get_rgb(guicolor_T pixel)
|
|
5080 {
|
|
5081 return (Red(pixel) << 16) + (Green(pixel) << 8) + Blue(pixel);
|
|
5082 }
|
|
5083
|
|
5084
|
|
5085
|
|
5086 #ifdef FEAT_BROWSE
|
|
5087 /*
|
|
5088 * Pop open a file browser and return the file selected, in allocated memory,
|
|
5089 * or NULL if Cancel is hit.
|
|
5090 * saving - TRUE if the file will be saved to, FALSE if it will be opened.
|
|
5091 * title - Title message for the file browser dialog.
|
|
5092 * dflt - Default name of file.
|
|
5093 * ext - Default extension to be added to files without extensions.
|
|
5094 * initdir - directory in which to open the browser (NULL = current dir)
|
|
5095 * filter - Filter for matched files to choose from.
|
|
5096 * Has a format like this:
|
|
5097 * "C Files (*.c)\0*.c\0"
|
|
5098 * "All Files\0*.*\0\0"
|
|
5099 * If these two strings were concatenated, then a choice of two file
|
|
5100 * filters will be selectable to the user. Then only matching files will
|
|
5101 * be shown in the browser. If NULL, the default allows all files.
|
|
5102 *
|
|
5103 * *NOTE* - the filter string must be terminated with TWO nulls.
|
|
5104 */
|
|
5105 char_u *
|
|
5106 gui_mch_browse(
|
|
5107 int saving,
|
|
5108 char_u *title,
|
|
5109 char_u *dflt,
|
|
5110 char_u *ext,
|
|
5111 char_u *initdir,
|
|
5112 char_u *filter)
|
|
5113 {
|
|
5114 /* TODO: Add Ammon's safety checl (Dany) */
|
|
5115 NavReplyRecord reply;
|
|
5116 char_u *fname = NULL;
|
|
5117 char_u **fnames = NULL;
|
|
5118 long numFiles;
|
|
5119 NavDialogOptions navOptions;
|
|
5120 OSErr error;
|
|
5121
|
|
5122 /* Get Navigation Service Defaults value */
|
9
|
5123 NavGetDefaultDialogOptions(&navOptions);
|
7
|
5124
|
|
5125
|
|
5126 /* TODO: If we get a :browse args, set the Multiple bit. */
|
|
5127 navOptions.dialogOptionFlags = kNavAllowInvisibleFiles
|
|
5128 | kNavDontAutoTranslate
|
|
5129 | kNavDontAddTranslateItems
|
|
5130 /* | kNavAllowMultipleFiles */
|
|
5131 | kNavAllowStationery;
|
|
5132
|
9
|
5133 (void) C2PascalString(title, &navOptions.message);
|
|
5134 (void) C2PascalString(dflt, &navOptions.savedFileName);
|
7
|
5135 /* Could set clientName?
|
|
5136 * windowTitle? (there's no title bar?)
|
|
5137 */
|
|
5138
|
|
5139 if (saving)
|
|
5140 {
|
|
5141 /* Change first parm AEDesc (typeFSS) *defaultLocation to match dflt */
|
9
|
5142 NavPutFile(NULL, &reply, &navOptions, NULL, 'TEXT', 'VIM!', NULL);
|
7
|
5143 if (!reply.validRecord)
|
|
5144 return NULL;
|
|
5145 }
|
|
5146 else
|
|
5147 {
|
|
5148 /* Change first parm AEDesc (typeFSS) *defaultLocation to match dflt */
|
|
5149 NavGetFile(NULL, &reply, &navOptions, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL);
|
|
5150 if (!reply.validRecord)
|
|
5151 return NULL;
|
|
5152 }
|
|
5153
|
|
5154 fnames = new_fnames_from_AEDesc(&reply.selection, &numFiles, &error);
|
|
5155
|
9
|
5156 NavDisposeReply(&reply);
|
7
|
5157
|
|
5158 if (fnames)
|
|
5159 {
|
|
5160 fname = fnames[0];
|
|
5161 vim_free(fnames);
|
|
5162 }
|
|
5163
|
|
5164 /* TODO: Shorten the file name if possible */
|
|
5165 return fname;
|
|
5166 }
|
|
5167 #endif /* FEAT_BROWSE */
|
|
5168
|
|
5169 #ifdef FEAT_GUI_DIALOG
|
|
5170 /*
|
|
5171 * Stuff for dialogues
|
|
5172 */
|
|
5173
|
|
5174 /*
|
|
5175 * Create a dialogue dynamically from the parameter strings.
|
|
5176 * type = type of dialogue (question, alert, etc.)
|
|
5177 * title = dialogue title. may be NULL for default title.
|
|
5178 * message = text to display. Dialogue sizes to accommodate it.
|
|
5179 * buttons = '\n' separated list of button captions, default first.
|
|
5180 * dfltbutton = number of default button.
|
|
5181 *
|
|
5182 * This routine returns 1 if the first button is pressed,
|
|
5183 * 2 for the second, etc.
|
|
5184 *
|
|
5185 * 0 indicates Esc was pressed.
|
|
5186 * -1 for unexpected error
|
|
5187 *
|
|
5188 * If stubbing out this fn, return 1.
|
|
5189 */
|
|
5190
|
|
5191 typedef struct
|
|
5192 {
|
|
5193 short idx;
|
|
5194 short width; /* Size of the text in pixel */
|
|
5195 Rect box;
|
|
5196 } vgmDlgItm; /* Vim Gui_Mac.c Dialog Item */
|
|
5197
|
|
5198 #define MoveRectTo(r,x,y) OffsetRect(r,x-r->left,y-r->top)
|
|
5199
|
|
5200 static void
|
|
5201 macMoveDialogItem(
|
|
5202 DialogRef theDialog,
|
|
5203 short itemNumber,
|
|
5204 short X,
|
|
5205 short Y,
|
|
5206 Rect *inBox)
|
|
5207 {
|
|
5208 #if 0 /* USE_CARBONIZED */
|
|
5209 /* Untested */
|
9
|
5210 MoveDialogItem(theDialog, itemNumber, X, Y);
|
7
|
5211 if (inBox != nil)
|
9
|
5212 GetDialogItem(theDialog, itemNumber, &itemType, &itemHandle, inBox);
|
7
|
5213 #else
|
|
5214 short itemType;
|
|
5215 Handle itemHandle;
|
|
5216 Rect localBox;
|
|
5217 Rect *itemBox = &localBox;
|
|
5218
|
|
5219 if (inBox != nil)
|
|
5220 itemBox = inBox;
|
|
5221
|
9
|
5222 GetDialogItem(theDialog, itemNumber, &itemType, &itemHandle, itemBox);
|
|
5223 OffsetRect(itemBox, -itemBox->left, -itemBox->top);
|
|
5224 OffsetRect(itemBox, X, Y);
|
7
|
5225 /* To move a control (like a button) we need to call both
|
|
5226 * MoveControl and SetDialogItem. FAQ 6-18 */
|
|
5227 if (1) /*(itemType & kControlDialogItem) */
|
9
|
5228 MoveControl((ControlRef) itemHandle, X, Y);
|
|
5229 SetDialogItem(theDialog, itemNumber, itemType, itemHandle, itemBox);
|
7
|
5230 #endif
|
|
5231 }
|
|
5232
|
|
5233 static void
|
|
5234 macSizeDialogItem(
|
|
5235 DialogRef theDialog,
|
|
5236 short itemNumber,
|
|
5237 short width,
|
|
5238 short height)
|
|
5239 {
|
|
5240 short itemType;
|
|
5241 Handle itemHandle;
|
|
5242 Rect itemBox;
|
|
5243
|
9
|
5244 GetDialogItem(theDialog, itemNumber, &itemType, &itemHandle, &itemBox);
|
7
|
5245
|
|
5246 /* When width or height is zero do not change it */
|
|
5247 if (width == 0)
|
|
5248 width = itemBox.right - itemBox.left;
|
|
5249 if (height == 0)
|
|
5250 height = itemBox.bottom - itemBox.top;
|
|
5251
|
|
5252 #if 0 /* USE_CARBONIZED */
|
9
|
5253 SizeDialogItem(theDialog, itemNumber, width, height); /* Untested */
|
7
|
5254 #else
|
|
5255 /* Resize the bounding box */
|
|
5256 itemBox.right = itemBox.left + width;
|
|
5257 itemBox.bottom = itemBox.top + height;
|
|
5258
|
|
5259 /* To resize a control (like a button) we need to call both
|
|
5260 * SizeControl and SetDialogItem. (deducted from FAQ 6-18) */
|
|
5261 if (itemType & kControlDialogItem)
|
9
|
5262 SizeControl((ControlRef) itemHandle, width, height);
|
7
|
5263
|
|
5264 /* Configure back the item */
|
9
|
5265 SetDialogItem(theDialog, itemNumber, itemType, itemHandle, &itemBox);
|
7
|
5266 #endif
|
|
5267 }
|
|
5268
|
|
5269 static void
|
|
5270 macSetDialogItemText(
|
|
5271 DialogRef theDialog,
|
|
5272 short itemNumber,
|
|
5273 Str255 itemName)
|
|
5274 {
|
|
5275 short itemType;
|
|
5276 Handle itemHandle;
|
|
5277 Rect itemBox;
|
|
5278
|
9
|
5279 GetDialogItem(theDialog, itemNumber, &itemType, &itemHandle, &itemBox);
|
7
|
5280
|
|
5281 if (itemType & kControlDialogItem)
|
9
|
5282 SetControlTitle((ControlRef) itemHandle, itemName);
|
7
|
5283 else
|
9
|
5284 SetDialogItemText(itemHandle, itemName);
|
7
|
5285 }
|
|
5286
|
593
|
5287 /* TODO: There have been some crashes with dialogs, check your inbox
|
|
5288 * (Jussi)
|
|
5289 */
|
7
|
5290 int
|
|
5291 gui_mch_dialog(
|
|
5292 int type,
|
|
5293 char_u *title,
|
|
5294 char_u *message,
|
|
5295 char_u *buttons,
|
|
5296 int dfltbutton,
|
|
5297 char_u *textfield)
|
|
5298 {
|
|
5299 Handle buttonDITL;
|
|
5300 Handle iconDITL;
|
|
5301 Handle inputDITL;
|
|
5302 Handle messageDITL;
|
|
5303 Handle itemHandle;
|
|
5304 Handle iconHandle;
|
|
5305 DialogPtr theDialog;
|
|
5306 char_u len;
|
|
5307 char_u PascalTitle[256]; /* place holder for the title */
|
|
5308 char_u name[256];
|
|
5309 GrafPtr oldPort;
|
|
5310 short itemHit;
|
|
5311 char_u *buttonChar;
|
|
5312 Rect box;
|
|
5313 short button;
|
|
5314 short lastButton;
|
|
5315 short itemType;
|
|
5316 short useIcon;
|
|
5317 short width;
|
|
5318 short totalButtonWidth = 0; /* the width of all button together incuding spacing */
|
|
5319 short widestButton = 0;
|
|
5320 short dfltButtonEdge = 20; /* gut feeling */
|
|
5321 short dfltElementSpacing = 13; /* from IM:V.2-29 */
|
|
5322 short dfltIconSideSpace = 23; /* from IM:V.2-29 */
|
|
5323 short maximumWidth = 400; /* gut feeling */
|
|
5324 short maxButtonWidth = 175; /* gut feeling */
|
|
5325
|
|
5326 short vertical;
|
|
5327 short dialogHeight;
|
|
5328 short messageLines = 3;
|
|
5329 FontInfo textFontInfo;
|
|
5330
|
|
5331 vgmDlgItm iconItm;
|
|
5332 vgmDlgItm messageItm;
|
|
5333 vgmDlgItm inputItm;
|
|
5334 vgmDlgItm buttonItm;
|
|
5335
|
|
5336 WindowRef theWindow;
|
|
5337
|
|
5338 /* Check 'v' flag in 'guioptions': vertical button placement. */
|
|
5339 vertical = (vim_strchr(p_go, GO_VERTICAL) != NULL);
|
|
5340
|
|
5341 /* Create a new Dialog Box from template. */
|
9
|
5342 theDialog = GetNewDialog(129, nil, (WindowRef) -1);
|
7
|
5343
|
|
5344 /* Get the WindowRef */
|
|
5345 theWindow = GetDialogWindow(theDialog);
|
|
5346
|
|
5347 /* Hide the window.
|
|
5348 * 1. to avoid seeing slow drawing
|
|
5349 * 2. to prevent a problem seen while moving dialog item
|
|
5350 * within a visible window. (non-Carbon MacOS 9)
|
|
5351 * Could be avoided by changing the resource.
|
|
5352 */
|
9
|
5353 HideWindow(theWindow);
|
7
|
5354
|
|
5355 /* Change the graphical port to the dialog,
|
|
5356 * so we can measure the text with the proper font */
|
9
|
5357 GetPort(&oldPort);
|
|
5358 SetPortDialogPort(theDialog);
|
7
|
5359
|
|
5360 /* Get the info about the default text,
|
|
5361 * used to calculate the height of the message
|
|
5362 * and of the text field */
|
|
5363 GetFontInfo(&textFontInfo);
|
|
5364
|
|
5365 /* Set the dialog title */
|
|
5366 if (title != NULL)
|
|
5367 {
|
9
|
5368 (void) C2PascalString(title, &PascalTitle);
|
|
5369 SetWTitle(theWindow, PascalTitle);
|
7
|
5370 }
|
|
5371
|
|
5372 /* Creates the buttons and add them to the Dialog Box. */
|
9
|
5373 buttonDITL = GetResource('DITL', 130);
|
7
|
5374 buttonChar = buttons;
|
|
5375 button = 0;
|
|
5376
|
|
5377 for (;*buttonChar != 0;)
|
|
5378 {
|
|
5379 /* Get the name of the button */
|
|
5380 button++;
|
|
5381 len = 0;
|
|
5382 for (;((*buttonChar != DLG_BUTTON_SEP) && (*buttonChar != 0) && (len < 255)); buttonChar++)
|
|
5383 {
|
|
5384 if (*buttonChar != DLG_HOTKEY_CHAR)
|
|
5385 name[++len] = *buttonChar;
|
|
5386 }
|
|
5387 if (*buttonChar != 0)
|
|
5388 buttonChar++;
|
|
5389 name[0] = len;
|
|
5390
|
|
5391 /* Add the button */
|
9
|
5392 AppendDITL(theDialog, buttonDITL, overlayDITL); /* appendDITLRight); */
|
7
|
5393
|
|
5394 /* Change the button's name */
|
9
|
5395 macSetDialogItemText(theDialog, button, name);
|
7
|
5396
|
|
5397 /* Resize the button to fit its name */
|
9
|
5398 width = StringWidth(name) + 2 * dfltButtonEdge;
|
7
|
5399 /* Limite the size of any button to an acceptable value. */
|
|
5400 /* TODO: Should be based on the message width */
|
|
5401 if (width > maxButtonWidth)
|
|
5402 width = maxButtonWidth;
|
9
|
5403 macSizeDialogItem(theDialog, button, width, 0);
|
7
|
5404
|
|
5405 totalButtonWidth += width;
|
|
5406
|
|
5407 if (width > widestButton)
|
|
5408 widestButton = width;
|
|
5409 }
|
9
|
5410 ReleaseResource(buttonDITL);
|
7
|
5411 lastButton = button;
|
|
5412
|
|
5413 /* Add the icon to the Dialog Box. */
|
|
5414 iconItm.idx = lastButton + 1;
|
9
|
5415 iconDITL = GetResource('DITL', 131);
|
7
|
5416 switch (type)
|
|
5417 {
|
|
5418 case VIM_GENERIC: useIcon = kNoteIcon;
|
|
5419 case VIM_ERROR: useIcon = kStopIcon;
|
|
5420 case VIM_WARNING: useIcon = kCautionIcon;
|
|
5421 case VIM_INFO: useIcon = kNoteIcon;
|
|
5422 case VIM_QUESTION: useIcon = kNoteIcon;
|
|
5423 default: useIcon = kStopIcon;
|
|
5424 };
|
9
|
5425 AppendDITL(theDialog, iconDITL, overlayDITL);
|
|
5426 ReleaseResource(iconDITL);
|
|
5427 GetDialogItem(theDialog, iconItm.idx, &itemType, &itemHandle, &box);
|
7
|
5428 /* TODO: Should the item be freed? */
|
9
|
5429 iconHandle = GetIcon(useIcon);
|
|
5430 SetDialogItem(theDialog, iconItm.idx, itemType, iconHandle, &box);
|
7
|
5431
|
|
5432 /* Add the message to the Dialog box. */
|
|
5433 messageItm.idx = lastButton + 2;
|
9
|
5434 messageDITL = GetResource('DITL', 132);
|
|
5435 AppendDITL(theDialog, messageDITL, overlayDITL);
|
|
5436 ReleaseResource(messageDITL);
|
|
5437 GetDialogItem(theDialog, messageItm.idx, &itemType, &itemHandle, &box);
|
|
5438 (void) C2PascalString(message, &name);
|
|
5439 SetDialogItemText(itemHandle, name);
|
|
5440 messageItm.width = StringWidth(name);
|
7
|
5441
|
|
5442 /* Add the input box if needed */
|
|
5443 if (textfield != NULL)
|
|
5444 {
|
857
|
5445 /* Cheat for now reuse the message and convert to text edit */
|
7
|
5446 inputItm.idx = lastButton + 3;
|
9
|
5447 inputDITL = GetResource('DITL', 132);
|
|
5448 AppendDITL(theDialog, inputDITL, overlayDITL);
|
|
5449 ReleaseResource(inputDITL);
|
|
5450 GetDialogItem(theDialog, inputItm.idx, &itemType, &itemHandle, &box);
|
|
5451 /* SetDialogItem(theDialog, inputItm.idx, kEditTextDialogItem, itemHandle, &box);*/
|
|
5452 (void) C2PascalString(textfield, &name);
|
|
5453 SetDialogItemText(itemHandle, name);
|
|
5454 inputItm.width = StringWidth(name);
|
7
|
5455 }
|
|
5456
|
|
5457 /* Set the <ENTER> and <ESC> button. */
|
9
|
5458 SetDialogDefaultItem(theDialog, dfltbutton);
|
|
5459 SetDialogCancelItem(theDialog, 0);
|
7
|
5460
|
|
5461 /* Reposition element */
|
|
5462
|
|
5463 /* Check if we need to force vertical */
|
|
5464 if (totalButtonWidth > maximumWidth)
|
|
5465 vertical = TRUE;
|
|
5466
|
|
5467 /* Place icon */
|
9
|
5468 macMoveDialogItem(theDialog, iconItm.idx, dfltIconSideSpace, dfltElementSpacing, &box);
|
7
|
5469 iconItm.box.right = box.right;
|
|
5470 iconItm.box.bottom = box.bottom;
|
|
5471
|
|
5472 /* Place Message */
|
|
5473 messageItm.box.left = iconItm.box.right + dfltIconSideSpace;
|
9
|
5474 macSizeDialogItem(theDialog, messageItm.idx, 0, messageLines * (textFontInfo.ascent + textFontInfo.descent));
|
|
5475 macMoveDialogItem(theDialog, messageItm.idx, messageItm.box.left, dfltElementSpacing, &messageItm.box);
|
7
|
5476
|
|
5477 /* Place Input */
|
|
5478 if (textfield != NULL)
|
|
5479 {
|
|
5480 inputItm.box.left = messageItm.box.left;
|
|
5481 inputItm.box.top = messageItm.box.bottom + dfltElementSpacing;
|
9
|
5482 macSizeDialogItem(theDialog, inputItm.idx, 0, textFontInfo.ascent + textFontInfo.descent);
|
|
5483 macMoveDialogItem(theDialog, inputItm.idx, inputItm.box.left, inputItm.box.top, &inputItm.box);
|
7
|
5484 /* Convert the static text into a text edit.
|
|
5485 * For some reason this change need to be done last (Dany) */
|
9
|
5486 GetDialogItem(theDialog, inputItm.idx, &itemType, &itemHandle, &inputItm.box);
|
|
5487 SetDialogItem(theDialog, inputItm.idx, kEditTextDialogItem, itemHandle, &inputItm.box);
|
7
|
5488 SelectDialogItemText(theDialog, inputItm.idx, 0, 32767);
|
|
5489 }
|
|
5490
|
|
5491 /* Place Button */
|
|
5492 if (textfield != NULL)
|
|
5493 {
|
|
5494 buttonItm.box.left = inputItm.box.left;
|
|
5495 buttonItm.box.top = inputItm.box.bottom + dfltElementSpacing;
|
|
5496 }
|
|
5497 else
|
|
5498 {
|
|
5499 buttonItm.box.left = messageItm.box.left;
|
|
5500 buttonItm.box.top = messageItm.box.bottom + dfltElementSpacing;
|
|
5501 }
|
|
5502
|
|
5503 for (button=1; button <= lastButton; button++)
|
|
5504 {
|
|
5505
|
9
|
5506 macMoveDialogItem(theDialog, button, buttonItm.box.left, buttonItm.box.top, &box);
|
7
|
5507 /* With vertical, it's better to have all button the same lenght */
|
|
5508 if (vertical)
|
|
5509 {
|
9
|
5510 macSizeDialogItem(theDialog, button, widestButton, 0);
|
|
5511 GetDialogItem(theDialog, button, &itemType, &itemHandle, &box);
|
7
|
5512 }
|
|
5513 /* Calculate position of next button */
|
|
5514 if (vertical)
|
|
5515 buttonItm.box.top = box.bottom + dfltElementSpacing;
|
|
5516 else
|
|
5517 buttonItm.box.left = box.right + dfltElementSpacing;
|
|
5518 }
|
|
5519
|
|
5520 /* Resize the dialog box */
|
|
5521 dialogHeight = box.bottom + dfltElementSpacing;
|
|
5522 SizeWindow(theWindow, maximumWidth, dialogHeight, TRUE);
|
|
5523
|
|
5524 /* Magic resize */
|
9
|
5525 AutoSizeDialog(theDialog);
|
7
|
5526 /* Need a horizontal resize anyway so not that useful */
|
|
5527
|
|
5528 /* Display it */
|
|
5529 ShowWindow(theWindow);
|
|
5530 /* BringToFront(theWindow); */
|
|
5531 SelectWindow(theWindow);
|
|
5532
|
9
|
5533 /* DrawDialog(theDialog); */
|
7
|
5534 #if 0
|
9
|
5535 GetPort(&oldPort);
|
|
5536 SetPortDialogPort(theDialog);
|
7
|
5537 #endif
|
|
5538
|
857
|
5539 #ifdef USE_CARBONKEYHANDLER
|
|
5540 /* Avoid that we use key events for the main window. */
|
|
5541 dialog_busy = TRUE;
|
|
5542 #endif
|
|
5543
|
7
|
5544 /* Hang until one of the button is hit */
|
|
5545 do
|
|
5546 {
|
9
|
5547 ModalDialog(nil, &itemHit);
|
7
|
5548 } while ((itemHit < 1) || (itemHit > lastButton));
|
|
5549
|
857
|
5550 #ifdef USE_CARBONKEYHANDLER
|
|
5551 dialog_busy = FALSE;
|
|
5552 #endif
|
|
5553
|
7
|
5554 /* Copy back the text entered by the user into the param */
|
|
5555 if (textfield != NULL)
|
|
5556 {
|
9
|
5557 GetDialogItem(theDialog, inputItm.idx, &itemType, &itemHandle, &box);
|
|
5558 GetDialogItemText(itemHandle, (char_u *) &name);
|
7
|
5559 #if IOSIZE < 256
|
|
5560 /* Truncate the name to IOSIZE if needed */
|
|
5561 if (name[0] > IOSIZE)
|
|
5562 name[0] = IOSIZE - 1;
|
|
5563 #endif
|
418
|
5564 vim_strncpy(textfield, &name[1], name[0]);
|
7
|
5565 }
|
|
5566
|
|
5567 /* Restore the original graphical port */
|
9
|
5568 SetPort(oldPort);
|
7
|
5569
|
|
5570 /* Get ride of th edialog (free memory) */
|
9
|
5571 DisposeDialog(theDialog);
|
7
|
5572
|
|
5573 return itemHit;
|
|
5574 /*
|
|
5575 * Usefull thing which could be used
|
|
5576 * SetDialogTimeout(): Auto click a button after timeout
|
|
5577 * SetDialogTracksCursor() : Get the I-beam cursor over input box
|
|
5578 * MoveDialogItem(): Probably better than SetDialogItem
|
|
5579 * SizeDialogItem(): (but is it Carbon Only?)
|
|
5580 * AutoSizeDialog(): Magic resize of dialog based on text lenght
|
|
5581 */
|
|
5582 }
|
|
5583 #endif /* FEAT_DIALOG_GUI */
|
|
5584
|
|
5585 /*
|
|
5586 * Display the saved error message(s).
|
|
5587 */
|
|
5588 #ifdef USE_MCH_ERRMSG
|
|
5589 void
|
593
|
5590 display_errors(void)
|
7
|
5591 {
|
|
5592 char *p;
|
|
5593 char_u pError[256];
|
|
5594
|
593
|
5595 if (error_ga.ga_data == NULL)
|
|
5596 return;
|
|
5597
|
|
5598 /* avoid putting up a message box with blanks only */
|
|
5599 for (p = (char *)error_ga.ga_data; *p; ++p)
|
|
5600 if (!isspace(*p))
|
|
5601 {
|
|
5602 if (STRLEN(p) > 255)
|
|
5603 pError[0] = 255;
|
|
5604 else
|
|
5605 pError[0] = STRLEN(p);
|
|
5606
|
|
5607 STRNCPY(&pError[1], p, pError[0]);
|
|
5608 ParamText(pError, nil, nil, nil);
|
|
5609 Alert(128, nil);
|
|
5610 break;
|
|
5611 /* TODO: handled message longer than 256 chars
|
|
5612 * use auto-sizeable alert
|
|
5613 * or dialog with scrollbars (TextEdit zone)
|
|
5614 */
|
|
5615 }
|
|
5616 ga_clear(&error_ga);
|
7
|
5617 }
|
|
5618 #endif
|
|
5619
|
|
5620 /*
|
87
|
5621 * Get current mouse coordinates in text window.
|
7
|
5622 */
|
95
|
5623 void
|
|
5624 gui_mch_getmouse(int *x, int *y)
|
7
|
5625 {
|
|
5626 Point where;
|
|
5627
|
|
5628 GetMouse(&where);
|
|
5629
|
87
|
5630 *x = where.h;
|
|
5631 *y = where.v;
|
7
|
5632 }
|
|
5633
|
|
5634 void
|
593
|
5635 gui_mch_setmouse(int x, int y)
|
7
|
5636 {
|
|
5637 /* TODO */
|
|
5638 #if 0
|
|
5639 /* From FAQ 3-11 */
|
|
5640
|
|
5641 CursorDevicePtr myMouse;
|
|
5642 Point where;
|
|
5643
|
9
|
5644 if ( NGetTrapAddress(_CursorDeviceDispatch, ToolTrap)
|
|
5645 != NGetTrapAddress(_Unimplemented, ToolTrap))
|
7
|
5646 {
|
|
5647 /* New way */
|
|
5648
|
|
5649 /*
|
|
5650 * Get first devoice with one button.
|
|
5651 * This will probably be the standad mouse
|
|
5652 * startat head of cursor dev list
|
|
5653 *
|
|
5654 */
|
|
5655
|
|
5656 myMouse = nil;
|
|
5657
|
|
5658 do
|
|
5659 {
|
|
5660 /* Get the next cursor device */
|
|
5661 CursorDeviceNextDevice(&myMouse);
|
|
5662 }
|
9
|
5663 while ((myMouse != nil) && (myMouse->cntButtons != 1));
|
|
5664
|
|
5665 CursorDeviceMoveTo(myMouse, x, y);
|
7
|
5666 }
|
|
5667 else
|
|
5668 {
|
|
5669 /* Old way */
|
|
5670 where.h = x;
|
|
5671 where.v = y;
|
|
5672
|
|
5673 *(Point *)RawMouse = where;
|
|
5674 *(Point *)MTemp = where;
|
|
5675 *(Ptr) CrsrNew = 0xFFFF;
|
|
5676 }
|
|
5677 #endif
|
|
5678 }
|
|
5679
|
|
5680 void
|
593
|
5681 gui_mch_show_popupmenu(vimmenu_T *menu)
|
7
|
5682 {
|
|
5683 /*
|
|
5684 * Clone PopUp to use menu
|
|
5685 * Create a object descriptor for the current selection
|
|
5686 * Call the procedure
|
|
5687 */
|
|
5688
|
|
5689 MenuHandle CntxMenu;
|
|
5690 Point where;
|
|
5691 OSStatus status;
|
|
5692 UInt32 CntxType;
|
|
5693 SInt16 CntxMenuID;
|
|
5694 UInt16 CntxMenuItem;
|
|
5695 Str255 HelpName = "";
|
|
5696 GrafPtr savePort;
|
|
5697
|
|
5698 /* Save Current Port: On MacOS X we seem to lose the port */
|
9
|
5699 GetPort(&savePort); /*OSX*/
|
|
5700
|
|
5701 GetMouse(&where);
|
|
5702 LocalToGlobal(&where); /*OSX*/
|
7
|
5703 CntxMenu = menu->submenu_handle;
|
|
5704
|
|
5705 /* TODO: Get the text selection from Vim */
|
|
5706
|
|
5707 /* Call to Handle Popup */
|
1089
|
5708 status = ContextualMenuSelect(CntxMenu, where, false, kCMHelpItemRemoveHelp,
|
1012
|
5709 HelpName, NULL, &CntxType, &CntxMenuID, &CntxMenuItem);
|
7
|
5710
|
|
5711 if (status == noErr)
|
|
5712 {
|
|
5713 if (CntxType == kCMMenuItemSelected)
|
|
5714 {
|
|
5715 /* Handle the menu CntxMenuID, CntxMenuItem */
|
|
5716 /* The submenu can be handle directly by gui_mac_handle_menu */
|
1012
|
5717 /* But what about the current menu, is the menu changed by
|
|
5718 * ContextualMenuSelect */
|
9
|
5719 gui_mac_handle_menu((CntxMenuID << 16) + CntxMenuItem);
|
7
|
5720 }
|
|
5721 else if (CntxMenuID == kCMShowHelpSelected)
|
|
5722 {
|
|
5723 /* Should come up with the help */
|
|
5724 }
|
|
5725 }
|
|
5726
|
|
5727 /* Restore original Port */
|
9
|
5728 SetPort(savePort); /*OSX*/
|
7
|
5729 }
|
|
5730
|
|
5731 #if defined(FEAT_CW_EDITOR) || defined(PROTO)
|
|
5732 /* TODO: Is it need for MACOS_X? (Dany) */
|
|
5733 void
|
|
5734 mch_post_buffer_write(buf_T *buf)
|
|
5735 {
|
9
|
5736 GetFSSpecFromPath(buf->b_ffname, &buf->b_FSSpec);
|
|
5737 Send_KAHL_MOD_AE(buf);
|
7
|
5738 }
|
|
5739 #endif
|
|
5740
|
|
5741 #ifdef FEAT_TITLE
|
|
5742 /*
|
|
5743 * Set the window title and icon.
|
|
5744 * (The icon is not taken care of).
|
|
5745 */
|
|
5746 void
|
593
|
5747 gui_mch_settitle(char_u *title, char_u *icon)
|
7
|
5748 {
|
|
5749 /* TODO: Get vim to make sure maxlen (from p_titlelen) is smaller
|
|
5750 * that 256. Even better get it to fit nicely in the titlebar.
|
|
5751 */
|
766
|
5752 #ifdef MACOS_CONVERT
|
168
|
5753 CFStringRef windowTitle;
|
|
5754 size_t windowTitleLen;
|
|
5755 #else
|
7
|
5756 char_u *pascalTitle;
|
168
|
5757 #endif
|
7
|
5758
|
|
5759 if (title == NULL) /* nothing to do */
|
|
5760 return;
|
|
5761
|
766
|
5762 #ifdef MACOS_CONVERT
|
168
|
5763 windowTitleLen = STRLEN(title);
|
|
5764 windowTitle = mac_enc_to_cfstring(title, windowTitleLen);
|
|
5765
|
|
5766 if (windowTitle)
|
|
5767 {
|
|
5768 SetWindowTitleWithCFString(gui.VimWindow, windowTitle);
|
|
5769 CFRelease(windowTitle);
|
|
5770 }
|
|
5771 #else
|
7
|
5772 pascalTitle = C2Pascal_save(title);
|
|
5773 if (pascalTitle != NULL)
|
|
5774 {
|
|
5775 SetWTitle(gui.VimWindow, pascalTitle);
|
|
5776 vim_free(pascalTitle);
|
|
5777 }
|
168
|
5778 #endif
|
7
|
5779 }
|
|
5780 #endif
|
|
5781
|
|
5782 /*
|
|
5783 * Transfered from os_mac.c for MacOS X using os_unix.c prep work
|
|
5784 */
|
|
5785
|
|
5786 int
|
593
|
5787 C2PascalString(char_u *CString, Str255 *PascalString)
|
7
|
5788 {
|
|
5789 char_u *PascalPtr = (char_u *) PascalString;
|
|
5790 int len;
|
|
5791 int i;
|
|
5792
|
|
5793 PascalPtr[0] = 0;
|
|
5794 if (CString == NULL)
|
|
5795 return 0;
|
|
5796
|
|
5797 len = STRLEN(CString);
|
|
5798 if (len > 255)
|
|
5799 len = 255;
|
|
5800
|
|
5801 for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
|
|
5802 PascalPtr[i+1] = CString[i];
|
|
5803
|
|
5804 PascalPtr[0] = len;
|
|
5805
|
|
5806 return 0;
|
|
5807 }
|
|
5808
|
|
5809 int
|
593
|
5810 GetFSSpecFromPath(char_u *file, FSSpec *fileFSSpec)
|
7
|
5811 {
|
|
5812 /* From FAQ 8-12 */
|
|
5813 Str255 filePascal;
|
|
5814 CInfoPBRec myCPB;
|
|
5815 OSErr err;
|
|
5816
|
9
|
5817 (void) C2PascalString(file, &filePascal);
|
7
|
5818
|
|
5819 myCPB.dirInfo.ioNamePtr = filePascal;
|
|
5820 myCPB.dirInfo.ioVRefNum = 0;
|
|
5821 myCPB.dirInfo.ioFDirIndex = 0;
|
|
5822 myCPB.dirInfo.ioDrDirID = 0;
|
|
5823
|
9
|
5824 err= PBGetCatInfo(&myCPB, false);
|
7
|
5825
|
|
5826 /* vRefNum, dirID, name */
|
9
|
5827 FSMakeFSSpec(0, 0, filePascal, fileFSSpec);
|
7
|
5828
|
|
5829 /* TODO: Use an error code mechanism */
|
|
5830 return 0;
|
|
5831 }
|
|
5832
|
|
5833 /*
|
|
5834 * Convert a FSSpec to a fuill path
|
|
5835 */
|
|
5836
|
9
|
5837 char_u *FullPathFromFSSpec_save(FSSpec file)
|
7
|
5838 {
|
|
5839 /*
|
|
5840 * TODO: Add protection for 256 char max.
|
|
5841 */
|
|
5842
|
|
5843 CInfoPBRec theCPB;
|
|
5844 char_u fname[256];
|
|
5845 char_u *filenamePtr = fname;
|
|
5846 OSErr error;
|
|
5847 int folder = 1;
|
|
5848 #ifdef USE_UNIXFILENAME
|
|
5849 SInt16 dfltVol_vRefNum;
|
|
5850 SInt32 dfltVol_dirID;
|
|
5851 FSRef refFile;
|
|
5852 OSStatus status;
|
|
5853 UInt32 pathSize = 256;
|
|
5854 char_u pathname[256];
|
|
5855 char_u *path = pathname;
|
|
5856 #else
|
|
5857 Str255 directoryName;
|
|
5858 char_u temporary[255];
|
|
5859 char_u *temporaryPtr = temporary;
|
|
5860 #endif
|
|
5861
|
|
5862 #ifdef USE_UNIXFILENAME
|
|
5863 /* Get the default volume */
|
|
5864 /* TODO: Remove as this only work if Vim is on the Boot Volume*/
|
9
|
5865 error=HGetVol(NULL, &dfltVol_vRefNum, &dfltVol_dirID);
|
7
|
5866
|
|
5867 if (error)
|
|
5868 return NULL;
|
|
5869 #endif
|
|
5870
|
|
5871 /* Start filling fname with file.name */
|
418
|
5872 vim_strncpy(filenamePtr, &file.name[1], file.name[0]);
|
7
|
5873
|
|
5874 /* Get the info about the file specified in FSSpec */
|
|
5875 theCPB.dirInfo.ioFDirIndex = 0;
|
|
5876 theCPB.dirInfo.ioNamePtr = file.name;
|
|
5877 theCPB.dirInfo.ioVRefNum = file.vRefNum;
|
1106
|
5878 /*theCPB.hFileInfo.ioDirID = 0;*/
|
7
|
5879 theCPB.dirInfo.ioDrDirID = file.parID;
|
|
5880
|
|
5881 /* As ioFDirIndex = 0, get the info of ioNamePtr,
|
|
5882 which is relative to ioVrefNum, ioDirID */
|
9
|
5883 error = PBGetCatInfo(&theCPB, false);
|
7
|
5884
|
|
5885 /* If we are called for a new file we expect fnfErr */
|
|
5886 if ((error) && (error != fnfErr))
|
|
5887 return NULL;
|
|
5888
|
|
5889 /* Check if it's a file or folder */
|
|
5890 /* default to file if file don't exist */
|
|
5891 if (((theCPB.hFileInfo.ioFlAttrib & ioDirMask) == 0) || (error))
|
|
5892 folder = 0; /* It's not a folder */
|
|
5893 else
|
|
5894 folder = 1;
|
|
5895
|
|
5896 #ifdef USE_UNIXFILENAME
|
|
5897 /*
|
|
5898 * The function used here are available in Carbon, but
|
|
5899 * do nothing une MacOS 8 and 9
|
|
5900 */
|
|
5901 if (error == fnfErr)
|
|
5902 {
|
|
5903 /* If the file to be saved does not already exist, it isn't possible
|
|
5904 to convert its FSSpec into an FSRef. But we can construct an
|
|
5905 FSSpec for the file's parent folder (since we have its volume and
|
|
5906 directory IDs), and since that folder does exist, we can convert
|
|
5907 that FSSpec into an FSRef, convert the FSRef in turn into a path,
|
|
5908 and, finally, append the filename. */
|
|
5909 FSSpec dirSpec;
|
|
5910 FSRef dirRef;
|
|
5911 Str255 emptyFilename = "\p";
|
|
5912 error = FSMakeFSSpec(theCPB.dirInfo.ioVRefNum,
|
|
5913 theCPB.dirInfo.ioDrDirID, emptyFilename, &dirSpec);
|
|
5914 if (error)
|
|
5915 return NULL;
|
|
5916
|
|
5917 error = FSpMakeFSRef(&dirSpec, &dirRef);
|
|
5918 if (error)
|
|
5919 return NULL;
|
|
5920
|
|
5921 status = FSRefMakePath(&dirRef, (UInt8*)path, pathSize);
|
|
5922 if (status)
|
|
5923 return NULL;
|
|
5924
|
|
5925 STRCAT(path, "/");
|
|
5926 STRCAT(path, filenamePtr);
|
|
5927 }
|
|
5928 else
|
|
5929 {
|
|
5930 /* If the file to be saved already exists, we can get its full path
|
|
5931 by converting its FSSpec into an FSRef. */
|
9
|
5932 error=FSpMakeFSRef(&file, &refFile);
|
7
|
5933 if (error)
|
|
5934 return NULL;
|
|
5935
|
9
|
5936 status=FSRefMakePath(&refFile, (UInt8 *) path, pathSize);
|
7
|
5937 if (status)
|
|
5938 return NULL;
|
|
5939 }
|
|
5940
|
|
5941 /* Add a slash at the end if needed */
|
|
5942 if (folder)
|
9
|
5943 STRCAT(path, "/");
|
|
5944
|
|
5945 return (vim_strsave(path));
|
7
|
5946 #else
|
|
5947 /* TODO: Get rid of all USE_UNIXFILENAME below */
|
|
5948 /* Set ioNamePtr, it's the same area which is always reused. */
|
|
5949 theCPB.dirInfo.ioNamePtr = directoryName;
|
|
5950
|
|
5951 /* Trick for first entry, set ioDrParID to the first value
|
|
5952 * we want for ioDrDirID*/
|
|
5953 theCPB.dirInfo.ioDrParID = file.parID;
|
|
5954 theCPB.dirInfo.ioDrDirID = file.parID;
|
|
5955
|
9
|
5956 if ((TRUE) && (file.parID != fsRtDirID /*fsRtParID*/))
|
7
|
5957 do
|
|
5958 {
|
|
5959 theCPB.dirInfo.ioFDirIndex = -1;
|
|
5960 /* theCPB.dirInfo.ioNamePtr = directoryName; Already done above. */
|
|
5961 theCPB.dirInfo.ioVRefNum = file.vRefNum;
|
|
5962 /* theCPB.dirInfo.ioDirID = irrevelant when ioFDirIndex = -1 */
|
|
5963 theCPB.dirInfo.ioDrDirID = theCPB.dirInfo.ioDrParID;
|
|
5964
|
|
5965 /* As ioFDirIndex = -1, get the info of ioDrDirID, */
|
|
5966 /* *ioNamePtr[0 TO 31] will be updated */
|
9
|
5967 error = PBGetCatInfo(&theCPB,false);
|
7
|
5968
|
|
5969 if (error)
|
|
5970 return NULL;
|
|
5971
|
|
5972 /* Put the new directoryName in front of the current fname */
|
|
5973 STRCPY(temporaryPtr, filenamePtr);
|
418
|
5974 vim_strncpy(filenamePtr, &directoryName[1], directoryName[0]);
|
7
|
5975 STRCAT(filenamePtr, ":");
|
|
5976 STRCAT(filenamePtr, temporaryPtr);
|
|
5977 }
|
|
5978 #if 1 /* def USE_UNIXFILENAME */
|
|
5979 while ((theCPB.dirInfo.ioDrParID != fsRtDirID) /* && */
|
|
5980 /* (theCPB.dirInfo.ioDrDirID != fsRtDirID)*/);
|
|
5981 #else
|
|
5982 while (theCPB.dirInfo.ioDrDirID != fsRtDirID);
|
|
5983 #endif
|
|
5984
|
|
5985 /* Get the information about the volume on which the file reside */
|
|
5986 theCPB.dirInfo.ioFDirIndex = -1;
|
|
5987 /* theCPB.dirInfo.ioNamePtr = directoryName; Already done above. */
|
|
5988 theCPB.dirInfo.ioVRefNum = file.vRefNum;
|
|
5989 /* theCPB.dirInfo.ioDirID = irrevelant when ioFDirIndex = -1 */
|
|
5990 theCPB.dirInfo.ioDrDirID = theCPB.dirInfo.ioDrParID;
|
|
5991
|
|
5992 /* As ioFDirIndex = -1, get the info of ioDrDirID, */
|
|
5993 /* *ioNamePtr[0 TO 31] will be updated */
|
9
|
5994 error = PBGetCatInfo(&theCPB,false);
|
7
|
5995
|
|
5996 if (error)
|
|
5997 return NULL;
|
|
5998
|
|
5999 /* For MacOS Classic always add the volume name */
|
|
6000 /* For MacOS X add the volume name preceded by "Volumes" */
|
|
6001 /* when we are not refering to the boot volume */
|
|
6002 #ifdef USE_UNIXFILENAME
|
|
6003 if (file.vRefNum != dfltVol_vRefNum)
|
|
6004 #endif
|
|
6005 {
|
|
6006 /* Add the volume name */
|
|
6007 STRCPY(temporaryPtr, filenamePtr);
|
418
|
6008 vim_strncpy(filenamePtr, &directoryName[1], directoryName[0]);
|
7
|
6009 STRCAT(filenamePtr, ":");
|
|
6010 STRCAT(filenamePtr, temporaryPtr);
|
|
6011
|
|
6012 #ifdef USE_UNIXFILENAME
|
|
6013 STRCPY(temporaryPtr, filenamePtr);
|
|
6014 filenamePtr[0] = 0; /* NULL terminate the string */
|
|
6015 STRCAT(filenamePtr, "Volumes:");
|
|
6016 STRCAT(filenamePtr, temporaryPtr);
|
|
6017 #endif
|
|
6018 }
|
|
6019
|
|
6020 /* Append final path separator if it's a folder */
|
|
6021 if (folder)
|
9
|
6022 STRCAT(fname, ":");
|
7
|
6023
|
|
6024 /* As we use Unix File Name for MacOS X convert it */
|
|
6025 #ifdef USE_UNIXFILENAME
|
|
6026 /* Need to insert leading / */
|
|
6027 /* TODO: get the above code to use directly the / */
|
|
6028 STRCPY(&temporaryPtr[1], filenamePtr);
|
|
6029 temporaryPtr[0] = '/';
|
|
6030 STRCPY(filenamePtr, temporaryPtr);
|
|
6031 {
|
|
6032 char *p;
|
|
6033 for (p = fname; *p; p++)
|
|
6034 if (*p == ':')
|
|
6035 *p = '/';
|
|
6036 }
|
|
6037 #endif
|
|
6038
|
9
|
6039 return (vim_strsave(fname));
|
7
|
6040 #endif
|
|
6041 }
|
|
6042
|
|
6043 #if defined(USE_IM_CONTROL) || defined(PROTO)
|
|
6044 /*
|
|
6045 * Input Method Control functions.
|
|
6046 */
|
|
6047
|
|
6048 /*
|
|
6049 * Notify cursor position to IM.
|
|
6050 */
|
|
6051 void
|
|
6052 im_set_position(int row, int col)
|
|
6053 {
|
|
6054 /* TODO: Implement me! */
|
|
6055 }
|
|
6056
|
|
6057 /*
|
|
6058 * Set IM status on ("active" is TRUE) or off ("active" is FALSE).
|
|
6059 */
|
|
6060 void
|
|
6061 im_set_active(int active)
|
|
6062 {
|
|
6063 KeyScript(active ? smKeySysScript : smKeyRoman);
|
|
6064 }
|
|
6065
|
|
6066 /*
|
|
6067 * Get IM status. When IM is on, return not 0. Else return 0.
|
|
6068 */
|
|
6069 int
|
593
|
6070 im_get_status(void)
|
7
|
6071 {
|
|
6072 SInt32 script = GetScriptManagerVariable(smKeyScript);
|
|
6073 return (script != smRoman
|
|
6074 && script == GetScriptManagerVariable(smSysScript)) ? 1 : 0;
|
|
6075 }
|
1106
|
6076
|
7
|
6077 #endif /* defined(USE_IM_CONTROL) || defined(PROTO) */
|
1106
|
6078
|
|
6079
|
|
6080
|
|
6081
|
|
6082 #if defined(FEAT_GUI_TABLINE) || defined(PROTO)
|
|
6083 // drawer implementation
|
|
6084 static MenuRef contextMenu = NULL;
|
|
6085 enum
|
|
6086 {
|
|
6087 kTabContextMenuId = 42,
|
|
6088 };
|
|
6089
|
|
6090 // the caller has to CFRelease() the returned string
|
|
6091 static CFStringRef
|
|
6092 getTabLabel(tabpage_T *page)
|
|
6093 {
|
|
6094 get_tabline_label(page, FALSE);
|
|
6095 #ifdef MACOS_CONVERT
|
|
6096 return mac_enc_to_cfstring(NameBuff, STRLEN(NameBuff));
|
|
6097 #else
|
|
6098 // TODO: check internal encoding?
|
|
6099 return CFStringCreateWithCString(kCFAllocatorDefault, (char *)NameBuff,
|
|
6100 kCFStringEncodingMacRoman);
|
|
6101 #endif
|
|
6102 }
|
|
6103
|
|
6104
|
|
6105 #define DRAWER_SIZE 150
|
|
6106 #define DRAWER_INSET 16
|
|
6107
|
|
6108 static ControlRef dataBrowser = NULL;
|
|
6109
|
|
6110 // when the tabline is hidden, vim doesn't call update_tabline(). When
|
|
6111 // the tabline is shown again, show_tabline() is called before upate_tabline(),
|
|
6112 // and because of this, the tab labels and vims internal tabs are out of sync
|
|
6113 // for a very short time. to prevent inconsistent state, we store the labels
|
|
6114 // of the tabs, not pointers to the tabs (which are invalid for a short time).
|
|
6115 static CFStringRef *tabLabels = NULL;
|
|
6116 static int tabLabelsSize = 0;
|
|
6117
|
|
6118 enum
|
|
6119 {
|
|
6120 kTabsColumn = 'Tabs'
|
|
6121 };
|
|
6122
|
|
6123 static int
|
|
6124 getTabCount(void)
|
|
6125 {
|
|
6126 tabpage_T *tp;
|
|
6127 int numTabs = 0;
|
|
6128
|
|
6129 for (tp = first_tabpage; tp != NULL; tp = tp->tp_next)
|
|
6130 ++numTabs;
|
|
6131 return numTabs;
|
|
6132 }
|
|
6133
|
|
6134 // data browser item display callback
|
|
6135 static OSStatus
|
|
6136 dbItemDataCallback(ControlRef browser,
|
|
6137 DataBrowserItemID itemID,
|
|
6138 DataBrowserPropertyID property /* column id */,
|
|
6139 DataBrowserItemDataRef itemData,
|
|
6140 Boolean changeValue)
|
|
6141 {
|
|
6142 OSStatus status = noErr;
|
|
6143
|
|
6144 // assert(property == kTabsColumn); // why is this violated??
|
|
6145
|
|
6146 // changeValue is true if we have a modifieable list and data was changed.
|
|
6147 // In our case, it's always false.
|
|
6148 // (that is: if (changeValue) updateInternalData(); else return
|
|
6149 // internalData();
|
|
6150 if (!changeValue)
|
|
6151 {
|
|
6152 CFStringRef str;
|
|
6153
|
|
6154 assert(itemID - 1 >= 0 && itemID - 1 < tabLabelsSize);
|
|
6155 str = tabLabels[itemID - 1];
|
|
6156 status = SetDataBrowserItemDataText(itemData, str);
|
|
6157 }
|
|
6158 else
|
|
6159 status = errDataBrowserPropertyNotSupported;
|
|
6160
|
|
6161 return status;
|
|
6162 }
|
|
6163
|
|
6164 // data browser action callback
|
|
6165 static void
|
|
6166 dbItemNotificationCallback(ControlRef browser,
|
|
6167 DataBrowserItemID item,
|
|
6168 DataBrowserItemNotification message)
|
|
6169 {
|
|
6170 switch (message)
|
|
6171 {
|
|
6172 case kDataBrowserItemSelected:
|
|
6173 send_tabline_event(item);
|
|
6174 break;
|
|
6175 }
|
|
6176 }
|
|
6177
|
|
6178 // callbacks needed for contextual menu:
|
|
6179 static void
|
|
6180 dbGetContextualMenuCallback(ControlRef browser,
|
|
6181 MenuRef *menu,
|
|
6182 UInt32 *helpType,
|
|
6183 CFStringRef *helpItemString,
|
|
6184 AEDesc *selection)
|
|
6185 {
|
|
6186 // on mac os 9: kCMHelpItemNoHelp, but it's not the same
|
|
6187 *helpType = kCMHelpItemRemoveHelp; // OS X only ;-)
|
|
6188 *helpItemString = NULL;
|
|
6189
|
|
6190 *menu = contextMenu;
|
|
6191 }
|
|
6192
|
|
6193 static void
|
|
6194 dbSelectContextualMenuCallback(ControlRef browser,
|
|
6195 MenuRef menu,
|
|
6196 UInt32 selectionType,
|
|
6197 SInt16 menuID,
|
|
6198 MenuItemIndex menuItem)
|
|
6199 {
|
|
6200 if (selectionType == kCMMenuItemSelected)
|
|
6201 {
|
|
6202 MenuCommand command;
|
|
6203 GetMenuItemCommandID(menu, menuItem, &command);
|
|
6204
|
|
6205 // get tab that was selected when the context menu appeared
|
|
6206 // (there is always one tab selected). TODO: check if the context menu
|
|
6207 // isn't opened on an item but on empty space (has to be possible some
|
|
6208 // way, the finder does it too ;-) )
|
|
6209 Handle items = NewHandle(0);
|
|
6210 if (items != NULL)
|
|
6211 {
|
|
6212 int numItems;
|
|
6213
|
|
6214 GetDataBrowserItems(browser, kDataBrowserNoItem, false,
|
|
6215 kDataBrowserItemIsSelected, items);
|
|
6216 numItems = GetHandleSize(items) / sizeof(DataBrowserItemID);
|
|
6217 if (numItems > 0)
|
|
6218 {
|
|
6219 int idx;
|
|
6220 DataBrowserItemID *itemsPtr;
|
|
6221
|
|
6222 HLock(items);
|
|
6223 itemsPtr = (DataBrowserItemID *)*items;
|
|
6224 idx = itemsPtr[0];
|
|
6225 HUnlock(items);
|
|
6226 send_tabline_menu_event(idx, command);
|
|
6227 }
|
|
6228 DisposeHandle(items);
|
|
6229 }
|
|
6230 }
|
|
6231 }
|
|
6232
|
|
6233 // focus callback of the data browser to always leave focus in vim
|
|
6234 static OSStatus
|
|
6235 dbFocusCallback(EventHandlerCallRef handler, EventRef event, void *data)
|
|
6236 {
|
|
6237 assert(GetEventClass(event) == kEventClassControl
|
|
6238 && GetEventKind(event) == kEventControlSetFocusPart);
|
|
6239
|
|
6240 return paramErr;
|
|
6241 }
|
|
6242
|
|
6243
|
|
6244 // drawer callback to resize data browser to drawer size
|
|
6245 static OSStatus
|
|
6246 drawerCallback(EventHandlerCallRef handler, EventRef event, void *data)
|
|
6247 {
|
|
6248 switch (GetEventKind(event))
|
|
6249 {
|
|
6250 case kEventWindowBoundsChanged: // move or resize
|
|
6251 {
|
|
6252 UInt32 attribs;
|
|
6253 GetEventParameter(event, kEventParamAttributes, typeUInt32,
|
|
6254 NULL, sizeof(attribs), NULL, &attribs);
|
|
6255 if (attribs & kWindowBoundsChangeSizeChanged) // resize
|
|
6256 {
|
|
6257 Rect r;
|
|
6258 GetWindowBounds(drawer, kWindowContentRgn, &r);
|
|
6259 SetRect(&r, 0, 0, r.right - r.left, r.bottom - r.top);
|
|
6260 SetControlBounds(dataBrowser, &r);
|
|
6261 SetDataBrowserTableViewNamedColumnWidth(dataBrowser,
|
|
6262 kTabsColumn, r.right);
|
|
6263 }
|
|
6264 }
|
|
6265 break;
|
|
6266 }
|
|
6267
|
|
6268 return eventNotHandledErr;
|
|
6269 }
|
|
6270
|
|
6271 // Load DataBrowserChangeAttributes() dynamically on tiger (and better).
|
|
6272 // This way the code works on 10.2 and 10.3 as well (it doesn't have the
|
|
6273 // blue highlights in the list view on these systems, though. Oh well.)
|
|
6274
|
|
6275
|
|
6276 #import <mach-o/dyld.h>
|
|
6277
|
|
6278 enum { kMyDataBrowserAttributeListViewAlternatingRowColors = (1 << 1) };
|
|
6279
|
|
6280 static OSStatus
|
|
6281 myDataBrowserChangeAttributes(ControlRef inDataBrowser,
|
|
6282 OptionBits inAttributesToSet,
|
|
6283 OptionBits inAttributesToClear)
|
|
6284 {
|
|
6285 long osVersion;
|
|
6286 char *symbolName;
|
|
6287 NSSymbol symbol = NULL;
|
|
6288 OSStatus (*dataBrowserChangeAttributes)(ControlRef inDataBrowser,
|
|
6289 OptionBits inAttributesToSet, OptionBits inAttributesToClear);
|
|
6290
|
|
6291 Gestalt(gestaltSystemVersion, &osVersion);
|
|
6292 if (osVersion < 0x1040) // only supported for 10.4 (and up)
|
|
6293 return noErr;
|
|
6294
|
|
6295 // C name mangling...
|
|
6296 symbolName = "_DataBrowserChangeAttributes";
|
|
6297 if (!NSIsSymbolNameDefined(symbolName)
|
|
6298 || (symbol = NSLookupAndBindSymbol(symbolName)) == NULL)
|
|
6299 return noErr;
|
|
6300
|
|
6301 dataBrowserChangeAttributes = NSAddressOfSymbol(symbol);
|
|
6302 if (dataBrowserChangeAttributes == NULL)
|
|
6303 return noErr; // well...
|
|
6304 return dataBrowserChangeAttributes(inDataBrowser,
|
|
6305 inAttributesToSet, inAttributesToClear);
|
|
6306 }
|
|
6307
|
|
6308 static void
|
|
6309 initialise_tabline(void)
|
|
6310 {
|
|
6311 Rect drawerRect = { 0, 0, 0, DRAWER_SIZE };
|
|
6312 DataBrowserCallbacks dbCallbacks;
|
|
6313 EventTypeSpec focusEvent = {kEventClassControl, kEventControlSetFocusPart};
|
|
6314 EventTypeSpec resizeEvent = {kEventClassWindow, kEventWindowBoundsChanged};
|
|
6315 DataBrowserListViewColumnDesc colDesc;
|
|
6316
|
|
6317 // drawers have to have compositing enabled
|
|
6318 CreateNewWindow(kDrawerWindowClass,
|
|
6319 kWindowStandardHandlerAttribute
|
|
6320 | kWindowCompositingAttribute
|
|
6321 | kWindowResizableAttribute
|
|
6322 | kWindowLiveResizeAttribute,
|
|
6323 &drawerRect, &drawer);
|
|
6324
|
|
6325 SetThemeWindowBackground(drawer, kThemeBrushDrawerBackground, true);
|
|
6326 SetDrawerParent(drawer, gui.VimWindow);
|
|
6327 SetDrawerOffsets(drawer, kWindowOffsetUnchanged, DRAWER_INSET);
|
|
6328
|
|
6329
|
|
6330 // create list view embedded in drawer
|
|
6331 CreateDataBrowserControl(drawer, &drawerRect, kDataBrowserListView,
|
|
6332 &dataBrowser);
|
|
6333
|
|
6334 dbCallbacks.version = kDataBrowserLatestCallbacks;
|
|
6335 InitDataBrowserCallbacks(&dbCallbacks);
|
|
6336 dbCallbacks.u.v1.itemDataCallback =
|
|
6337 NewDataBrowserItemDataUPP(dbItemDataCallback);
|
|
6338 dbCallbacks.u.v1.itemNotificationCallback =
|
|
6339 NewDataBrowserItemNotificationUPP(dbItemNotificationCallback);
|
|
6340 dbCallbacks.u.v1.getContextualMenuCallback =
|
|
6341 NewDataBrowserGetContextualMenuUPP(dbGetContextualMenuCallback);
|
|
6342 dbCallbacks.u.v1.selectContextualMenuCallback =
|
|
6343 NewDataBrowserSelectContextualMenuUPP(dbSelectContextualMenuCallback);
|
|
6344
|
|
6345 SetDataBrowserCallbacks(dataBrowser, &dbCallbacks);
|
|
6346
|
|
6347 SetDataBrowserListViewHeaderBtnHeight(dataBrowser, 0); // no header
|
|
6348 SetDataBrowserHasScrollBars(dataBrowser, false, true); // only vertical
|
|
6349 SetDataBrowserSelectionFlags(dataBrowser,
|
|
6350 kDataBrowserSelectOnlyOne | kDataBrowserNeverEmptySelectionSet);
|
|
6351 SetDataBrowserTableViewHiliteStyle(dataBrowser,
|
|
6352 kDataBrowserTableViewFillHilite);
|
|
6353 Boolean b = false;
|
|
6354 SetControlData(dataBrowser, kControlEntireControl,
|
|
6355 kControlDataBrowserIncludesFrameAndFocusTag, sizeof(b), &b);
|
|
6356
|
|
6357 // enable blue background in data browser (this is only in 10.4 and vim
|
|
6358 // has to support older osx versions as well, so we have to load this
|
|
6359 // function dynamically)
|
|
6360 myDataBrowserChangeAttributes(dataBrowser,
|
|
6361 kMyDataBrowserAttributeListViewAlternatingRowColors, 0);
|
|
6362
|
|
6363 // install callback that keeps focus in vim and away from the data browser
|
|
6364 InstallControlEventHandler(dataBrowser, dbFocusCallback, 1, &focusEvent,
|
|
6365 NULL, NULL);
|
|
6366
|
|
6367 // install callback that keeps data browser at the size of the drawer
|
|
6368 InstallWindowEventHandler(drawer, drawerCallback, 1, &resizeEvent,
|
|
6369 NULL, NULL);
|
|
6370
|
|
6371 // add "tabs" column to data browser
|
|
6372 colDesc.propertyDesc.propertyID = kTabsColumn;
|
|
6373 colDesc.propertyDesc.propertyType = kDataBrowserTextType;
|
|
6374
|
|
6375 // add if items can be selected (?): kDataBrowserListViewSelectionColumn
|
|
6376 colDesc.propertyDesc.propertyFlags = kDataBrowserDefaultPropertyFlags;
|
|
6377
|
|
6378 colDesc.headerBtnDesc.version = kDataBrowserListViewLatestHeaderDesc;
|
|
6379 colDesc.headerBtnDesc.minimumWidth = 100;
|
|
6380 colDesc.headerBtnDesc.maximumWidth = 150;
|
|
6381 colDesc.headerBtnDesc.titleOffset = 0;
|
|
6382 colDesc.headerBtnDesc.titleString = CFSTR("Tabs");
|
|
6383 colDesc.headerBtnDesc.initialOrder = kDataBrowserOrderIncreasing;
|
|
6384 colDesc.headerBtnDesc.btnFontStyle.flags = 0; // use default font
|
|
6385 colDesc.headerBtnDesc.btnContentInfo.contentType = kControlContentTextOnly;
|
|
6386
|
|
6387 AddDataBrowserListViewColumn(dataBrowser, &colDesc, 0);
|
|
6388
|
|
6389 // create tabline popup menu required by vim docs (see :he tabline-menu)
|
|
6390 CreateNewMenu(kTabContextMenuId, 0, &contextMenu);
|
|
6391 AppendMenuItemTextWithCFString(contextMenu, CFSTR("Close"), 0,
|
|
6392 TABLINE_MENU_CLOSE, NULL);
|
|
6393 AppendMenuItemTextWithCFString(contextMenu, CFSTR("New Tab"), 0,
|
|
6394 TABLINE_MENU_NEW, NULL);
|
|
6395 AppendMenuItemTextWithCFString(contextMenu, CFSTR("Open Tab..."), 0,
|
|
6396 TABLINE_MENU_OPEN, NULL);
|
|
6397 }
|
|
6398
|
|
6399
|
|
6400 /*
|
|
6401 * Show or hide the tabline.
|
|
6402 */
|
|
6403 void
|
|
6404 gui_mch_show_tabline(int showit)
|
|
6405 {
|
|
6406 if (showit == 0)
|
|
6407 CloseDrawer(drawer, true);
|
|
6408 else
|
|
6409 OpenDrawer(drawer, kWindowEdgeRight, true);
|
|
6410 }
|
|
6411
|
|
6412 /*
|
|
6413 * Return TRUE when tabline is displayed.
|
|
6414 */
|
|
6415 int
|
|
6416 gui_mch_showing_tabline(void)
|
|
6417 {
|
|
6418 WindowDrawerState state = GetDrawerState(drawer);
|
|
6419
|
|
6420 return state == kWindowDrawerOpen || state == kWindowDrawerOpening;
|
|
6421 }
|
|
6422
|
|
6423 /*
|
|
6424 * Update the labels of the tabline.
|
|
6425 */
|
|
6426 void
|
|
6427 gui_mch_update_tabline(void)
|
|
6428 {
|
|
6429 tabpage_T *tp;
|
|
6430 int numTabs = getTabCount();
|
|
6431 int nr = 1;
|
|
6432 int curtabidx = 1;
|
|
6433
|
|
6434 // adjust data browser
|
|
6435 if (tabLabels != NULL)
|
|
6436 {
|
|
6437 int i;
|
|
6438
|
|
6439 for (i = 0; i < tabLabelsSize; ++i)
|
|
6440 CFRelease(tabLabels[i]);
|
|
6441 free(tabLabels);
|
|
6442 }
|
|
6443 tabLabels = (CFStringRef *)malloc(numTabs * sizeof(CFStringRef));
|
|
6444 tabLabelsSize = numTabs;
|
|
6445
|
|
6446 for (tp = first_tabpage; tp != NULL; tp = tp->tp_next, ++nr)
|
|
6447 {
|
|
6448 if (tp == curtab)
|
|
6449 curtabidx = nr;
|
|
6450 tabLabels[nr-1] = getTabLabel(tp);
|
|
6451 }
|
|
6452
|
|
6453 RemoveDataBrowserItems(dataBrowser, kDataBrowserNoItem, 0, NULL,
|
|
6454 kDataBrowserItemNoProperty);
|
|
6455 // data browser uses ids 1, 2, 3, ... numTabs per default, so we
|
|
6456 // can pass NULL for the id array
|
|
6457 AddDataBrowserItems(dataBrowser, kDataBrowserNoItem, numTabs, NULL,
|
|
6458 kDataBrowserItemNoProperty);
|
|
6459
|
|
6460 DataBrowserItemID item = curtabidx;
|
|
6461 SetDataBrowserSelectedItems(dataBrowser, 1, &item, kDataBrowserItemsAssign);
|
|
6462 }
|
|
6463
|
|
6464 /*
|
|
6465 * Set the current tab to "nr". First tab is 1.
|
|
6466 */
|
|
6467 void
|
|
6468 gui_mch_set_curtab(nr)
|
|
6469 int nr;
|
|
6470 {
|
|
6471 DataBrowserItemID item = nr;
|
|
6472 SetDataBrowserSelectedItems(dataBrowser, 1, &item, kDataBrowserItemsAssign);
|
|
6473
|
|
6474 // TODO: call something like this?: (or restore scroll position, or...)
|
|
6475 RevealDataBrowserItem(dataBrowser, item, kTabsColumn,
|
|
6476 kDataBrowserRevealOnly);
|
|
6477 }
|
|
6478
|
|
6479 #endif // FEAT_GUI_TABLINE
|